Attached files

file filename
EX-32 - EXHIBIT 32 - RIVERVIEW BANCORP INCriv10-k11exh32.htm
EX-23 - EXHIBIT 23 - RIVERVIEW BANCORP INCriv10-k11exh23.htm
EX-31.2 - EXHIBIT 31.1 - RIVERVIEW BANCORP INCriv10-k11exh312.htm
EX-31.1 - EXHIBIT 31.1 - RIVERVIEW BANCORP INCriv10-k11exh311.htm
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C.  20549
 
FORM 10-K

[X]
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2011OR

[  ]
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
Commission File Number: 0-22957
 
RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) 
                                   
 
Washington    91-1838969 
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)    (I.R.S. Employer I.D. Number) 
     
900 Washington St., Ste. 900, Vancouver, Washington    98660 
(Address of principal executive offices)    (Zip Code) 
     
Registrant's telephone number, including area code:    (360) 693-6650 
     
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:     
     
Common Stock, Par Value $.01 per share    Nasdaq Stock Market LLC 
(Title of Each Class)    (Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered) 
     
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:    None 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes o  No  x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.
Yes o  No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes x No o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes o  No o

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and disclosure will not be contained, to the best of the registrant's knowledge, in any definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendments to this Form 10-K   x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company.  See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
Large accelerated filer o                                                      Accelerated filer                                o           Non-accelerated filer o                                           Smaller Reporting Company x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes o  No   x

The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant, based on the closing sales price of the registrant's Common Stock as quoted on the Nasdaq Global Select Market System under the symbol "RVSB" on September 30, 2010 was $44,494,342 (22,471,890 shares at $1.98 per share).  As of May 31, 2011, there were issued and outstanding 22,471,890 shares of the registrant’s common stock.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Shareholders (Part III).

 

 


Table of Contents
PART I
 
PAGE
     
Item 1.
Business
4
Item 1A.
Risk Factors
34
Item 1B.
Unresolved Staff Comments
44
Item 2.
Properties
44
Item 3.
Legal Proceedings
44
Item 4.
[Removed and Reserved]
44
 
PART II
   
Item 5.
Market of Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
45
Item 6.
Selected Financial Data
47
Item 7.
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
49
Item 7A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
68
Item 8.
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
70
Item 9.
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
102
Item 9A.
Controls and Procedures
102
Item 9B.
Other Information
105
 
PART III
   
Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
105
Item 11.
Executive Compensation
105
Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholders
105
Item 13.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
106
Item 14.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
106
 
PART IV
   
Item 15.
Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
107
Signatures
 
108
Index to exhibits
109





 

 

Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

“Safe Harbor” statement under the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995: When used in this Form 10-K the words “believes,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “estimates,” “forecasts,” “intends,” “plans,” “targets,” “potentially,” “probably,” “projects,” “outlook,” or similar expressions or future or conditional verbs such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “would,” and “could,” or similar expression are intended to identify “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements include statements with respect to our beliefs, plans, objectives, goals, expectations, assumptions and statements about future performance.  These forward-looking statements are subject to known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the results anticipated, including, but not limited to: the credit risks of lending activities, including  changes in the level and trend of loan delinquencies and write-offs and changes in the Company’s allowance for loan losses and provision for loan losses that may be impacted by deterioration in the housing and commercial real estate markets; changes in general economic conditions, either nationally or in the Company’s market areas; changes in the levels of general interest rates, and the relative differences between short and long term interest rates, deposit interest rates, the Company’s net interest margin and funding sources; fluctuations in the demand for loans, the number of unsold homes, land and other properties and fluctuations in real estate values in the Company’s market areas;  secondary market conditions for loans and the Company’s ability to sell loans in the secondary market; results of examinations of us by the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”) or other regulatory authorities, including the possibility that any such regulatory authority may, among other things, require the Company to increase its reserve for loan losses, write-down assets, change Riverview Community Bank’s regulatory capital position or affect the Company’s ability to borrow funds or maintain or increase deposits, which could adversely affect its  liquidity and earnings; the Company’s compliance with  regulatory enforcement actions entered into with the OTS and the possibility that noncompliance could result in the imposition of additional enforcement actions and additional requirements or restrictions on its operations; legislative or regulatory changes that adversely affect the Company’s business including changes in regulatory policies and principles, or  the interpretation of regulatory capital or other rules; the Company’s ability to attract and retain deposits; further increases in premiums for deposit insurance; the Company’s ability to control operating costs and expenses; the use of estimates in determining fair value of certain of the Company’s assets, which estimates may prove to be incorrect and result in significant declines in valuation; difficulties in reducing risks associated with the loans on the Company’s balance sheet; staffing fluctuations in response to product demand or the implementation of corporate strategies that affect the Company’s workforce and potential associated charges; computer systems on which the Company depends could fail or experience a security breach; the Company’s ability to retain key members of its senior management team; costs and effects of litigation, including settlements and judgments; the Company’s ability to implement its business strategies; the Company’s ability to successfully integrate any assets, liabilities, customers, systems, and management personnel it may acquire into its operations and the Company’s ability to realize related revenue synergies and cost savings within expected time frames and any goodwill charges related thereto; increased competitive pressures among financial services companies; changes in consumer spending, borrowing and savings habits; the availability of resources to address changes in laws, rules, or regulations or to respond to regulatory actions; the Company’s ability to pay dividends on its common stock and interest or principal payments on its junior subordinated debentures; adverse changes in the securities markets; inability of key third-party providers to perform their obligations to us; changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by the financial institution regulatory agencies or the Financial Accounting Standards Board, including additional guidance and interpretation on accounting issues and details of the implementation of new accounting methods; other economic, competitive, governmental, regulatory, and technological factors affecting the Company’s operations, pricing, products and services and the other risks described from time to time in our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

The Company cautions readers not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. Moreover, you should treat these statements as speaking only as of the date they are made and based only on information then actually known to the Company. The Company does not undertake to revise any forward-looking statements to reflect the occurrence of anticipated or unanticipated events or circumstances after the date of such statements. These risks could cause our actual results for fiscal 2011 and beyond to differ materially from those expressed in any forward-looking statements by, or on behalf of, us and could negatively affect the Company’s operating and stock price performance.


 

 

PART I

Item 1.  Business

General

Riverview Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company" or “Riverview”), a Washington corporation, is the savings and loan holding company of Riverview Community Bank (the “Bank”). At March 31, 2011, the Company had total assets of $859.3 million, total deposit accounts of $716.5 million and shareholders' equity of $106.9 million. The Company’s executive offices are located in Vancouver Washington. As used throughout this report, the terms “we,” “our,” “us,” “Riverview” or the “Company” refer to Riverview Bancorp, Inc. and the Bank, unless the context otherwise requires.

Substantially all of the Company’s business is conducted through the Bank which is regulated by the Office of Thrift Supervision ("OTS"), its primary regulator, and by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC"), the insurer of its deposits. The Bank's deposits are insured by the FDIC up to applicable legal limits under the Deposit Insurance Fund ("DIF").  The Bank has been a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") of Seattle since 1937.

As a progressive, community-oriented financial services company, the Company emphasizes local, personal service to residents of its primary market area. The Company considers Clark, Cowlitz, Klickitat and Skamania counties of Washington and Multnomah, Clackamas and Marion counties of Oregon as its primary market area. The Counties of Clackamas, Multnomah, Clark and Skamania are part of the Portland metropolitan area as defined by the U.S. Census Bureau. The Company is engaged predominantly in the business of attracting deposits from the general public and using such funds in its primary market area to originate commercial business, commercial real estate, multi-family real estate, real estate construction, residential real estate and other consumer loans. Commercial business, commercial real estate and real estate construction loans have decreased to 83.6% of the loan portfolio at March 31, 2011 from 87.6% at March 31, 2010, decreasing the risk profile of the total loan portfolio. The Company’s strategy over the past several years has been to control balance sheet growth in order to improve its regulatory capital ratios, including the targeted reduction of residential construction related loans. Speculative construction loans, consisting of unsold properties under construction, represented $16.5 million, or 87.7% of the residential construction portfolio at March 31, 2011, compared to $30.6 million a year ago, a decline of 46.2%. Total real estate construction loans at March 31, 2011 declined to $27.4 million or 63.7% from $75.5 million a year ago. Land acquisition and development loans were $55.3 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $74.8 million a year ago, which represents a decline of 26.1%. Most recently, the Company’s primary focus has been on increasing commercial business loans, owner occupied commercial real estate loans and high-quality one-to-four family mortgage loans.

The Company’s goal is to deliver returns to shareholders by managing problem assets, increasing higher-yielding assets (in particular, commercial real estate and commercial loans), increasing core deposit balances, reducing expenses, hiring experienced employees with a commercial lending focus and exploring opportunistic acquisitions. The Company’s strategic plan includes targeting the commercial banking customer base in its primary market area, specifically small and medium size businesses, professionals and wealth building individuals. In pursuit of these goals, the Company manages growth while maintaining a significant amount of commercial and commercial real estate loans in its loan portfolio. Significant portions of these new loan originations carry adjustable rates, higher yields or shorter terms and higher credit risk than traditional fixed-rate mortgages. A related goal is to increase the proportion of personal and business checking account deposits used to fund new loan production. At March 31, 2011, checking accounts totaled $179.8 million, or 25.1% of our total deposit mix. The strategic plan also stresses increased emphasis on non-interest income, including increased fees for asset management and deposit service charges. The strategic plan is designed to enhance earnings, reduce interest rate risk and provide a more complete range of financial services to customers and the local communities the Company serves. The Company is well positioned to attract new customers and to increase its market share with seventeen branches, including ten in Clark County, two in the Portland metropolitan area and three lending centers.

The Company continuously reviews new products and services to provide its customers more financial options. All new technology and services are generally reviewed for business development and cost saving purposes. The Bank has implemented remote check capture at all of its branches and for selected customers of the Bank. The Company continues to experience growth in customer use of its online banking services, which allows customers to conduct a full range of services on a real-time basis, including balance inquiries, transfers and electronic bill paying. During fiscal 2011, the Company completed the upgrade of its online banking product for consumer customers, providing consumer customers greater flexibility and convenience in conducting their online banking. The Company is in the process of completing the upgrade to its online banking product for its business customers. The Company’s online service has also enhanced the delivery of cash management services to business customers. In addition, during fiscal 2010, the Company enrolled in an
 
 
 
4

 
 
internet deposit listing service. Under this listing service, the Company may post time deposit rates on an internet site where institutional investors have the ability to deposit funds with the Company. Furthermore, the Company may utilize the internet deposit listing service to purchase certificates of deposit at other financial institutions. The Company also began offering Insured Cash Sweep (ICS™), a reciprocal money market product, to its customers in December 2010. Both the ICS program, along with the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (CDARS™) program that was implemented in fiscal year 2009, allows customers access to FDIC insurance on deposits exceeding the $250,000 FDIC insurance limit.

Market Area

The Company conducts operations from its home office in Vancouver and seventeen branch offices located in Camas, Washougal, Stevenson, White Salmon, Battle Ground, Goldendale, Vancouver (seven branch offices) and Longview, Washington and Portland, Wood Village and Aumsville, Oregon. The Company operates a trust and financial services company, Riverview Asset Management Corp. (“RAMCorp”), located in downtown Vancouver, Washington.  Riverview Mortgage, a mortgage broker division of the Bank, originates mortgage loans for various mortgage companies predominantly in the Vancouver/Portland metropolitan areas, as well as for the Bank.  The Bank’s Business and Professional Banking Division, with two lending offices in Vancouver and one lending office in Portland, Oregon offers commercial and business banking services.

Vancouver is located in Clark County, Washington, which is just north of Portland, Oregon. Many businesses are located in the Vancouver area because of the favorable tax structure and lower energy costs in Washington as compared to Oregon. Companies located in the Vancouver area include Sharp Microelectronics, Hewlett Packard, Georgia Pacific, Underwriters Laboratory, Wafer Tech, Nautilus, Barrett Business Services and Fisher Investments, as well as several support industries. PeaceHealth has confirmed that it will be moving its headquarters to Vancouver and relocate 467 jobs to the area. In addition to this industry base, the Columbia River Gorge Scenic Area is a source of tourism, which has helped to transform the area from its past dependence on the timber industry.

During 2008, the national and regional residential lending market experienced a notable slowdown. This downturn, which has continued into 2011, has negatively affected the economy in our market area. As a result, we have experienced a decline in the values of real estate collateral supporting our construction real estate and land acquisition and development loans, and experienced increased loan delinquencies and defaults, primarily in our residential construction and land development loan portfolios. Throughout fiscal 2008 through 2011, higher than historical provision for loan losses has been the most significant factor affecting our operating results and, while we are encouraged by the continuing reduction in our exposure to residential construction and land development loans and the recent slowdown in the emergence of new problem assets, looking forward we anticipate our credit costs could remain elevated for the foreseeable future as compared to historical levels. Although our non-performing loans and provision for loan losses have decreased over the last fiscal year and economic conditions appear to have stabilized, a prolonged weak economy in our market area could result in additional increases in nonperforming assets, further increases in the provision for loan losses and loan charge-offs in the future. As a result, like most financial institutions, our future operating results and financial performance will be significantly affected by the course of recovery in our market areas from the recent recessionary downturn.

Unemployment in Clark County and Portland, Oregon both decreased during the quarter ended March 31, 2011. According to the Washington State Employment Security Department, unemployment in Clark County decreased to 10.5% in March 2011 compared to 12.7% at December 2010, 12.4% in September 2010 and 13.1% in June 2010. According to the Oregon Employment Department, unemployment in Portland decreased to 9.1% in March 2011 compared to 9.6% in December 2010, 10.0% in September 2010 and 10.0% in June 2010. Home values at March 31, 2011 in the Company’s market area remained lower than home values in 2010 and 2009, due in large part to an increase in the volume of foreclosures and short sales. However, home values have begun to stabilize after decreasing sharply during the past fiscal years. According to the Regional Multiple Listing Services (RMLS), inventory levels in Portland, Oregon have fallen to 7.1 months on March 2011, compared to 7.8 months on March 2010 and an inventory level high of 11.3 months in January 2011. Inventory levels in Clark County have increased to 8.3 months on March 2011, compared to 7.7 months on March 2010. However, inventory levels in Clark County have decreased from an inventory level high of 12.1 months in February 2011. Closed home sales in Clark County decreased 13.9% in March 2011 compared to March 2010. Closed home sales in Portland decreased 10.2% during the same time period. These decreases in closed home sales may be attributed to the expiration of the home buyer tax credit offered by the government during fiscal year 2010. Commercial real estate leasing activity in the Portland/Vancouver area has performed better than the residential real estate market, but it is generally affected by a slow economy later than other indicators. According to Norris Beggs Simpson, commercial
 
 
 
5

 
 
vacancy rates in Clark County and Portland Oregon were approximately 20.4% and 24.1%, respectively as of March 31, 2011.

Lending Activities

General.  At March 31, 2011, the Company's net loans receivable totaled $672.6 million, or 78.3% of total assets at that date. The principal lending activity of the Company is the origination of loans collateralized by commercial properties and commercial business loans. A substantial portion of the Company's loan portfolio is secured by real estate, either as primary or secondary collateral, located in its primary market area. The Company’s lending activities are subject to the written, non-discriminatory, underwriting standards and loan origination procedures established by the Bank’s Board of Directors (“Board”) and management. The customary sources of loan originations are realtors, walk-in customers, referrals and existing customers. The Bank also uses commissioned loan brokers and print advertising to market its products and services. Loans are approved at various levels of management, depending upon the amount of the loan.


 

 



        Loan Portfolio Analysis.  The following table sets forth the composition of the Company's loan portfolio by type of loan at the dates indicated.

   
At March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
   
Amount
   
Percent
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Commercial and construction:
                                                           
Commercial business
  $ 85,511       12.44 %   $ 108,368       14.76 %   $ 127,150       15.87 %   $ 109,585       14.28 %   $ 91,174       13.18 %
Other real estate mortgage
    461,955       67.19       459,178       62.52       447,652       55.88       429,422       55.97       360,930       52.19  
Real estate construction
    27,385       3.98       75,456       10.27       139,476       17.41       148,631       19.37       166,073       24.01  
Total commercial and
  construction
    574,851       83.61       643,002       87.55       714,278       89.16       687,638       89.62       618,177       89.38  
                                                                                 
Consumer:
                                                                               
Real estate one-to-four
  family
    110,437       16.06       88,861       12.10       83,762       10.46       75,922       9.90       69,808       10.10  
Other installment
    2,289       0.33       2,616       0.35       3,051       0.38       3,665       0.48       3,619       0.52  
Total consumer loans
    112,726       16.39       91,477       12.45       86,813       10.84       79,587       10.38       73,427       10.62  
                                                                                 
Total loans
    687,577       100.00 %     734,479       100.00 %     801,091       100.00 %     767,225       100.00 %     691,604       100.00 %
                                                                                 
Less:
                                                                               
Allowance for loan losses
    14,968               21,642               16,974               10,687               8,653          
Total loans receivable, net
  $ 672,609             $ 712,837             $ 784,117             $ 756,538             $ 682,951          

 

 

Loan Portfolio Composition.  The following tables set forth the composition of the Company's commercial and construction loan portfolio based on loan purpose at the dates indicated.

   
 
 
Commercial
   
Other
Real Estate
Mortgage
   
Real Estate
Construction
   
Commercial &
Construction
Total
     March 31, 2011
(In thousands)
                       
Commercial business
$
85,511
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
85,511
Commercial construction
 
-
   
-
   
8,608
   
8,608
Office buildings
 
-
   
95,529
   
-
   
95,529
Warehouse/industrial
 
-
   
49,627
   
-
   
49,627
Retail/shopping centers/strip malls
 
-
   
85,719
   
-
   
85,719
    Assisted living facilities
 
-
   
35,162
   
-
   
35,162
Single purpose facilities
 
-
   
98,651
   
-
   
98,651
Land
 
-
   
55,258
   
-
   
55,258
Multi-family
 
-
   
42,009
   
-
   
42,009
One-to-four family construction
 
-
   
-
   
18,777
   
18,777
Total
$
85,511
 
$
461,955
 
$
27,385
 
$
574,851

 

   
 
 
Commercial
   
Other
Real Estate
Mortgage
   
Real Estate 
Construction
   
Commercial &
Construction
Total
    March 31, 2010
(In thousands)
                       
Commercial business
$
108,368
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
108,368
Commercial construction
 
-
   
-
   
40,017
   
40,017
Office buildings
 
-
   
90,000
   
-
   
90,000
Warehouse/industrial
 
-
   
46,731
   
-
   
46,731
Retail/shopping centers/strip malls
 
-
   
80,982
   
-
   
80,982
    Assisted living facilities
 
-
   
39,604
   
-
   
39,604
Single purpose facilities
 
-
   
93,866
   
-
   
93,866
Land
 
-
   
74,779
   
-
   
74,779
Multi-family
 
-
   
33,216
   
-
   
33,216
One-to-four family construction
 
-
   
-
   
35,439
   
35,439
Total
$
108,368
 
$
459,178
 
$
75,456
 
$
643,002

Commercial Business Lending. At March 31, 2011, the commercial business loan portfolio totaled $85.5 million or 12.4% of total loans. The decline in commercial business loans is primarily due to lower utilization on lines of credit by commercial customers as a result of the weak economic conditions coupled with several large principal paydowns on existing loans. Commercial business loans are typically secured by business equipment, accounts receivable, inventory or other property. The Company’s commercial business loans may be structured as term loans or as lines of credit. Commercial term loans are generally made to finance the purchase of assets and usually have maturities of five years or less. Commercial lines of credit are typically made for the purpose of providing working capital and usually have a term of one year or less. Lines of credit are made at variable rates of interest equal to a negotiated margin above an index rate and term loans are at either a variable or fixed rate. The Company also generally obtains personal guarantees from financially capable parties based on a review of personal financial statements.

Commercial lending involves risks that are different from those associated with residential and commercial real estate lending. Our commercial business loans are primarily made based on the cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. The borrower’s cash flow may be unpredictable, and collateral securing these loans may fluctuate in value. Although commercial business loans are often collateralized by equipment, inventory, accounts receivable or other business assets, the liquidation of collateral in the event of default is often an insufficient source of repayment because accounts receivable may be uncollectible and inventories may be obsolete or of limited use, among other things.  Accordingly, the repayment of commercial business loans depends primarily on the cash flow and credit worthiness of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower.

Other Real Estate Mortgage Lending.  At March 31, 2011, the other real estate lending portfolio totaled $462.0 million, or 67.19% of total loans. The Company originates other real estate loans including office buildings, warehouse/industrial, retail and assisted living facilities (collectively “commercial real estate loans”); as well as multi-family loans primarily located in our market area. As a result of the contraction in the real estate market, the Company has ceased the origination of new land
 
 
 
8

 
 
acquisition and development loans. At March 31, 2011, owner occupied properties accounted for 29% of the Company’s commercial real estate portfolio and non-owner occupied properties accounted for 71%.

Commercial real estate loans typically have higher loan balances, are more difficult to evaluate and monitor, and involve a higher degree of risk than one-to-four family residential loans. As a result, commercial real estate, including multi-family, loans are generally priced at a higher rate of interest than residential one-to-four family loans. Often payments on loans secured by commercial properties are dependent on the successful operation and management of the property securing the loan or business conducted on the property securing the loan; therefore, repayment of these loans may be affected by adverse conditions in the real estate market or the economy. Real estate lending is generally considered to be collateral based lending with loan amounts based on predetermined loan to collateral values and liquidation of the underlying real estate collateral being viewed as the primary source of repayment in the event of borrower default. The Company seeks to minimize these risks by generally limiting the maximum loan-to-value ratio to 80% and strictly scrutinizing the financial condition of the borrower, the quality of the collateral and the management of the property securing the loan. Loans are secured by first mortgages and often require specified debt service coverage (“DSC”) ratios depending on the characteristics of the collateral. The Company generally imposes a minimum DSC ratio of 1.20 for loans secured by income producing properties. Rates and other terms on such loans generally depend on our assessment of credit risk after considering such factors as the borrower’s financial condition and credit history, loan-to-value ratio, DSC ratio and other factors.

The Company actively pursues commercial real estate loans; however, new loan originations were lower in fiscal year 2011 reflecting the weak economic conditions resulting in weak loan demand and a decline in creditworthy borrowers. At March 31, 2011, the Company had four commercial real estate loans totaling $1.4 million on non-accrual status. For more information concerning risks related to commercial real estate loans, see Item 1A. “Risk Factors – Our emphasis on commercial real estate lending may expose us to increased lending risks.”

Land acquisition and development loans are included in the other real estate mortgage portfolio balance, and represent loans made to developers for the purpose of acquiring raw land and/or for the subsequent development and sale of residential lots. Such loans typically finance land purchase and infrastructure development of properties (i.e. roads, utilities, etc.) with the aim of making improved lots ready for subsequent sale to consumers or builders for ultimate construction of residential units. The primary source of repayment is generally the cash flow from developer sale of lots or improved parcels of land, secondary sources and personal guarantees, which may provide an additional measure of security for such loans. Strong demand for housing led to loan growth in this category in recent years. However, the recent downturn in real estate has slowed lot and home sales within the Company’s markets. This has impacted certain developers by lengthening the marketing period of their projects and negatively affecting borrower’s liquidity and collateral values. The Company has focused on reducing these loans during the past two fiscal years and plans to continue to reduce these portfolios. At March 31, 2011, land acquisition and development loans totaled $55.3 million, or 8.04% of total loans compared to $74.8 million, or 10.18% of total loans at March 31, 2010. The largest land acquisition and development loan had an outstanding balance at March 31, 2011 of $6.4 million and was performing according to its original repayment terms. With the exception of three loans totaling $8.6 million, all of the land acquisition and development loans were secured by properties located in Washington and Oregon. At March 31, 2011, the Company had four land acquisition and development loans totaling $2.9 million on non-accrual status.

Real Estate Construction.  The Company originates three types of residential construction loans: (i) speculative construction loans, (ii) custom/presold construction loans and (iii) construction/permanent loans. The Company also originates construction loans for the development of business properties and multi-family dwellings. All of the Company’s real estate construction loans were made on properties located in Washington and Oregon.

The composition of the Company’s construction loan portfolio including undisbursed funds at March 31, 2011 was as follows:
 
   
At March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Amount (1)
   
Percent
   
Amount (1)
   
Percent
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
Speculative construction
  $ 17,322       40.19 %   $ 31,209       35.20  
%
Commercial/multi-family construction
    19,684       45.67       47,975       54.11    
Custom/presold construction
    2,609       6.05       1,531       1.73    
Construction/permanent
    3,489       8.09       7,941       8.96    
Total
  $ 43,104       100.00 %   $ 88,656       100.00  
%

(1) Includes undisbursed funds of $15.8 million and $13.2 million at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 

 
 
9

 
The Company has remained diligent in managing its construction loan portfolio and has continued to be successful at reducing its overall exposure to residential construction and commercial construction loans. At March 31, 2011, the balance of the Company’s construction loan portfolio, including loan commitments, was $43.1 million compared to $88.7 million at March 31, 2010. The $45.6 million reduction was a result of loan repayments, charge-offs and foreclosures reflecting the Company’s efforts to reduce its exposure to these types of loans. The Company plans to continue its focus on aggressively managing its construction loan portfolio in fiscal year 2012. Additionally, the Company has significantly slowed the origination of new construction loans. In general, the Company is only originating new construction loans to facilitate the sale of existing loans or real estate owned (“REO”) properties; or on a very limited basis to selected borrowers.
 
Speculative construction loans are made to home builders and are termed “speculative” because the home builder does not have, at the time of loan origination, a signed contract with a home buyer who has a commitment for permanent financing with either the Company or another lender for the finished home. The home buyer may be identified either during or after the construction period, with the risk that the builder will have to debt service the speculative construction loan and finance real estate taxes and other carrying costs of the completed home for a significant time after the completion of construction until a home buyer is identified. Included in speculative construction loans are loans to finance the construction of townhouses and condominiums. At March 31, 2011, loans for the construction of townhouses and condominiums totaled $2.7 million and $10.8 million, respectively. At March 31, 2011, the Company had four borrowers with aggregate outstanding loan balances of more than $1.0 million, which totaled $12.1 million (the largest of which was $5.6 million) and were secured by properties located in the Company’s market area. At March 31, 2011, three speculative construction loans totaling $4.2 million were on non-accrual status.

The composition of speculative construction and land acquisition and development loans by geographical area is as follows:
 
   
Northwest
Oregon
   
Other
Oregon
   
Southwest
Washington
   
Other
Washington
   
Other
   
Total
 
March 31, 2011
  (In thousands)  
                                     
Land development
  $ 6,074     $ 4,159     $ 36,183     $ -     $ 8,842     $ 55,258  
Speculative construction
    2,118       8,491       5,716       149       -       16,474  
Total land and spec construction
  $ 8,192     $ 12,650     $ 41,899     $ 149     $ 8,842     $ 71,732  

Unlike speculative construction loans, presold construction loans are made for homes that have buyers. Presold construction loans are made to homebuilders who, at the time of construction, have a signed contract with a home buyer who has a commitment for permanent financing for the finished home from the Company or another lender. Custom construction loans are made to the homeowner. Custom/presold construction loans are generally originated for a term of 12 months. At March 31, 2011, the largest custom construction loan had an outstanding balance of $958,000 and was performing according to the original repayment terms. The largest presold construction loan had an outstanding balance of $235,000 and was performing according to the original repayment terms. At March 31, 2011, the Company had no presold construction loans or custom construction loans on non-accrual status.

Construction/permanent loans are originated to the homeowner rather than the homebuilder along with a commitment by the Company to originate a permanent loan to the homeowner to repay the construction loan at the completion of construction. The construction phase of a construction/permanent loan generally lasts six to nine months. At the completion of construction, the Company may either originate a fixed rate mortgage loan or an adjustable rate mortgage (“ARM”) loan or use its mortgage brokerage capabilities to obtain permanent financing for the customer with another lender. At completion of construction, the interest rate of the Company-originated fixed rate permanent loan is set at a market rate and for adjustable rate loans, the interest rates adjust on their first adjustment date.  See “—Mortgage Brokerage,” and “—Mortgage Loan Servicing.” At March 31, 2011, the largest outstanding construction/permanent loan had an outstanding balance of $503,000 and was performing according to its original repayment terms. At March 31, 2011, the Company had no construction/permanent loans on non-accrual status.

The Company provides construction financing for non-residential business properties and multi-family dwellings. At March 31, 2011, such loans totaled $8.6 million, or 31.4% of total real estate construction loans and 1.3% of total loans. Borrowers may be the business owner/occupier of the building who intends to operate its business from the property upon construction, or non-owner developers. The expected source of repayment of these loans is typically the sale or refinancing of the project upon completion of the construction phase. In certain circumstances, the Company may provide or commit to take-out financing upon construction. Take-out financing is subject to the project meeting specific underwriting guidelines. No assurance can be given that such take-out financing will be available upon project completion. These loans are secured by office buildings, retail rental space, mini storage facilities, assisted living facilities and multi-family dwellings located in the Company’s market area. At March 31, 2011, the largest commercial construction loan had a balance of $3.2 million and was
 
 
 
10

 
 
performing according to its original repayment terms. At March 31, 2011, the Company had no commercial construction loan on non-accrual status.

Construction lending affords the Company the opportunity to achieve higher interest rates and fees with shorter terms to maturity than the rates and fees generated by its single-family permanent mortgage lending. Construction lending, however, generally involves a higher degree of risk than single-family permanent mortgage lending because of the inherent difficulty in estimating both a property’s value at completion of the project and the estimated cost of the project, as well as the time needed to sell the property at completion. The nature of these loans is such that they are generally more difficult to evaluate and monitor. Because of the uncertainties inherent in estimating construction costs, as well as the market value of the completed project and the effects of governmental regulation of real property, it is relatively difficult to evaluate accurately the total funds required to complete a project and the related loan-to-value ratio. This type of lending also typically involves higher loan principal amounts and is often concentrated with a small number of builders. As a result, construction loans often involve the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project and the ability of the borrower to sell or lease the property or refinance the indebtedness, rather than the ability of the borrower or guarantor to repay principal and interest. If our appraisal of the value of the completed project proves to be overstated, we may have inadequate security for the repayment of the loan upon completion of construction of the project and may incur a loss. For additional information concerning the risks related to construction lending, see Item 1A. “Risk Factors – Our real estate construction and land acquisition loans are based upon estimates of costs and the value of the completed project.”

The Company has originated construction and land acquisition and development loans where a component of the cost of the project was the interest required to service the debt during the construction period of the loan, sometimes known as interest reserves. The Company allows disbursements of this interest component as long as the project is progressing as originally projected and if there has been no deterioration in the financial standing of the borrower or the underlying project. If the Company makes a determination that there is such deterioration, or if the loan becomes nonperforming, the Company halts any disbursement of those funds identified for use in paying interest. In some cases, additional interest reserves may be taken by use of deposited funds or through credit lines secured by separate and additional collateral.

Consumer Lending. Consumer loans totaled $112.7 million at March 31, 2011. Consumer lending is comprised of one-to-four family mortgage loans, home equity lines of credit, land loans to consumers for the future construction of one-to-four family homes, totaling $110.4 million, and other secured and unsecured consumer loans, totaling $2.3 million at March 31, 2011.

One-to-four family residences located in the Company’s primary market area secure the majority of the residential loans. Underwriting standards require that one-to-four family portfolio loans generally be owner occupied and that loan amounts not exceed 80% (95% with private mortgage insurance) of the lesser of current appraised value or cost of the underlying collateral. Terms typically range from 15 to 30 years. The Company also offers balloon mortgage loans with terms of either five or seven years and originates both fixed rate mortgages and ARMs with repricing based on the one-year constant maturity U.S. Treasury index or other index.  At March 31, 2011, the Company had seven one-to-four family loans totaling $957,000 on non-accrual status. All of these loans were located in Oregon and Washington.

During fiscal year 2011, the Company made the decision to increase its one-to-four family loan portfolio with a focus on increasing certain high-quality mortgages. The Bank has a mortgage program in place that offers competitive loan pricing for borrowers that meet our new increased underwriting standards for loan-to-value, credit scores, debt to income ratios and job history.

The Company originates a variety of installment loans, including loans for debt consolidation and other purposes, automobile loans, boat loans and savings account loans. Consumer loans generally entail greater risk than do residential mortgage loans, particularly in the case of consumer loans that are unsecured or secured by assets that depreciate rapidly, such as mobile homes, automobiles, boats and recreational vehicles. At March 31, 2011, the Company had no installment loans on non-accrual status.


 
11 

 

Loan Maturity. The following table sets forth certain information at March 31, 2011 regarding the dollar amount of loans maturing in the Company’s portfolio based on their contractual terms to maturity, but does not include potential prepayments.  Demand loans, loans having no stated schedule of repayments and no stated maturity and overdrafts are reported as due in one year or less.  Loan balances are reported net of deferred fees.
 
   
Within
1 Year
   
1 – 3 Years
   
After 3 – 5
Years
   
After 5 – 10
Years
   
Beyond 10
Years
   
Total
Commercial and construction:
 
(In thousands)
   Commercial business
$
45,554
 
$
17,969
 
$
9,069
 
$
12,706
 
$
213
 
$
85,511
   Other real estate mortgage
 
83,027
   
51,419
   
71,610
   
245,234
   
10,665
   
461,955
   Real estate construction
 
25,993
   
747
   
262
   
383
   
-
   
27,385
 Total commercial & construction
 
154,574
   
70,135
   
80,941
   
258,323
   
10,878
   
574,851
Consumer:
                                 
   Real estate one-to-four family
 
5,086
   
10,811
   
2,458
   
13,220
   
78,862
   
110,437
   Other installment
 
127
   
483
   
710
   
933
   
36
   
2,289
Total consumer
 
5,213
   
11,294
   
3,168
   
14,153
   
78,898
   
112,726
Total loans
$
159,787
 
$
81,429
 
$
84,109
 
$
272,476
 
$
89,776
 
$
687,577

The following table sets forth the dollar amount of all loans due after one year from March 31, 2011, which have fixed interest rates and have adjustable interest rates.

   
Fixed
Rate
   
Adjustable
Rate
   
Total
 
   
(In thousands)
 
Commercial and Construction:
                 
   Commercial business
$
24,073
 
$
15,884
 
$
39,957
 
   Other real estate mortgage
 
74,555
   
304,373
   
378,928
 
   Real estate construction
 
-
   
1,392
   
1,392
 
      Total commercial and construction
 
98,628
   
321,649
   
420,277
 
Consumer:
                 
   Real estate one-to-four family
 
62,561
   
42,790
   
105,351
 
   Other installment
 
1,547
   
615
   
2,162
 
      Total consumer
 
64,108
   
43,405
   
107,513
 
Total loans
$
162,736
 
$
365,054
 
$
527,790
 

Loan Commitments. The Company issues commitments to originate commercial loans, other real estate mortgage loans, construction loans, residential mortgage loans and other installment loans conditioned upon the occurrence of certain events. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments as it does for on-balance sheet instruments. Commitments to originate loans are conditional, and are honored for up to 45 days subject to the Company’s usual terms and conditions. Collateral is not required to support commitments. At March 31, 2011, the Company had outstanding commitments to originate loans of $8.1 million, compared to $12.4 million at March 31, 2010.

Mortgage Brokerage. In addition to originating mortgage loans for retention in its portfolio, the Company employs three commissioned brokers who originate mortgage loans (including construction loans) for various mortgage companies, as well as for the Company. The loans brokered to mortgage companies are closed in the name of, and funded by the purchasing mortgage company and are not originated as an asset of the Company. In return, the Company receives a fee ranging from 1.5% to 2.0% of the loan amount that it shares with the commissioned broker. Loans brokered to the Company are closed on the Company's books and the commissioned broker receives a fee of approximately 0.55% of the loan amount. During the year ended March 31, 2011, brokered loans totaled $41.5 million (including $21.3 million brokered to the Company), compared to $90.5 million of brokered loan in fiscal year 2010. Gross fees of $252,000 (excluding the portion of fees shared with the commissioned brokers) were recognized for the year ended March 31, 2011. The interest rate environment has a strong influence on the loan volume and amount of fees generated from the mortgage broker activity. In general, during periods of rising interest rates the volume of loans and the amount of loan fees generally decrease as a result of slower mortgage loan demand. Conversely, during periods of falling interest rates, the volume of loans and the amount of loan fees generally increase as a result of the increased mortgage loan demand. Due to a decrease in real estate loan sales activity as compared to fiscal year 2010, during which homeowners took advantage of historically low interest rates and government incentives, our loan volume and amount of fees generated decreased in fiscal year 2011.


 
12 

 

Mortgage Loan Servicing.  The Company is a qualified servicer for the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“FHLMC”).  The Company generally sells fixed-rate residential one-to-four mortgage loans that it originates with maturities of 15 years or more and balloon mortgages to the FHLMC as part of its asset liability strategy.  Mortgage loans are sold to FHLMC on a non-recourse basis whereby foreclosure losses are generally the responsibility of FHLMC and not the Company.  The Company's general policy is to close its residential loans on the FHLMC modified loan documents to facilitate future sales to FHLMC.  Upon sale, the Company continues to collect payments on the loans, to supervise foreclosure proceedings, and to otherwise service the loans. At March 31, 2011, total loans serviced for others were $123.4 million, of which $103.4 million were serviced for FHLMC.
 
Nonperforming Assets.  Loans are reviewed regularly and it is the Company’s general policy that when a loan is 90 days delinquent or when collection of principal or interest appears doubtful, it is placed on non-accrual status, at which time the accrual of interest ceases and a reserve for any unrecoverable accrued interest is established and charged against operations. Payments received on non-accrual loans are applied to reduce the outstanding principal balance on a cash-basis method.

Nonperforming assets were $39.9 million or 4.65% of total assets at March 31, 2011 compared with $49.3 million or 5.89% of total assets at March 31, 2010. The Company also had net charge-offs totaling $11.7 million during fiscal 2011 compared to $11.2 million during fiscal 2010. Credit quality challenges continue to be centered in residential land acquisition and development loans and speculative construction loans. The continuing relatively weak real estate market in our primary market area resulted in slower sales and excess housing inventory was the primary cause of the continued elevated levels of delinquencies and foreclosures for such loans. While the Company has not engaged in any sub-prime lending programs, the effect on home values, housing markets and construction lending from problems associated with sub-prime and other non-traditional mortgage lending programs has also contributed to the increased levels of builder and developer delinquencies during recent periods. Although it appears the economic conditions have stabilized, a prolonged weak economy in our market area could result in additional increases in nonperforming assets, further increases in the provision for loan losses and charge-offs in the future.

As noted above, the problem loans identified by the Company have continued to remain concentrated in speculative construction loans and land acquisition and development loans. During the current fiscal year, management continued its focus on managing these portfolios in an attempt to minimize the effects of declining home values and slower home sales. At March 31, 2011, the Company’s residential construction and land development loan portfolios were $18.8 million and $55.3 million, respectively as compared to $35.4 million and $74.8 million at March 31, 2010. The percentage of nonperforming loans in the residential construction and land development portfolios was 22.40% and 5.26%, respectively as compared to 33.3% and 16.2%, respectively, a year ago. For the year ended March 31, 2011, the charge-off ratio for the residential construction and land development portfolios was 15.94% and 6.32%, respectively.

Nonperforming loans were $12.3 million or 1.79% of total loans at March 31, 2011 compared with $36.0 million or 4.90% of total loans at March 31, 2010. The decrease in nonperforming loans was due to a general stabilization in the economic environment and an overall improvement in the credit environment, resulting in a slowdown in new problem credits as well as the transfer of loans into REO.  At March 31, 2011, nonperforming loans consisted of thirty loans to twenty-six borrowers ranging in size from $25,000 to $2.1 million. As noted above, land acquisition and development loans and speculative construction loans continue to represent the largest portion of our nonperforming loans, totaling $7.1 million, or 57.7%, of the total nonperforming loan balance at March 31, 2011. The remaining balance includes twelve commercial loans to ten borrowers totaling $2.9 million, four commercial real estate loans to four borrowers totaling $1.4 million, and seven residential real estate loans to seven borrowers totaling $957,000. All of these loans are to borrowers located in Oregon and Washington with the exception of one land acquisition and development loans totaling $1.4 million to a Washington borrower who has property located in Southern California. Thirteen of the Company’s nonperforming loans, totaling $9.5 million or 77.2% of total nonperforming loans, were measured for impairment at March 31, 2011. The specific reserve associated with these impaired loans totaled $167,000.

At March 31, 2011, the largest single nonperforming loan totaled $2.1 million. This loan was made to a builder/developer of a condominium project in Multnomah County of Portland, Oregon. Net charge-offs for this property totaled $1.5 million for fiscal year 2011. The Company believes that it is adequately reserved for this loan.

The balance of nonperforming assets included $27.6 million in REO at March 31, 2011. The REO was comprised of single-family homes totaling $3.6 million, residential building lots totaling $8.7 million, commercial real estate property totaling $8.4 million and land development property totaling $6.9 million. Furthermore, included in the $27.6 million in REO is $8.3 million of real estate held for investment by the Company comprised of a single commercial real estate property totaling $6.5 million and residential building lots totaling $1.8 million.  All of the REO properties are located in Oregon and Washington.
 
 
 
13

 
 
As a result of the declining real estate values, the Company had $924,000 in write-downs on existing REO properties during fiscal year 2011; however, gains of $386,000 were recognized on the sale of properties. Total REO sales were $7.6 million during fiscal 2011. Maintenance and operating expenses for these properties totaled $893,000 during fiscal year 2011. The orderly resolution of nonperforming loans and REO properties remains a priority for management. Because of the uncertain real estate market, no assurance can be given as to the timing of ultimate disposition of such assets or that the selling price will be at or above the carrying value. Continued declines in market values in our area could lead to additional valuation adjustments, which would have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

The coverage ratio of allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans was 121.46% at March 31, 2011 compared to 60.10% at March 31, 2010. This coverage ratio increased from March 31, 2010 primarily as a result of the decrease in nonperforming loans.

At March 31, 2011, the Company had trouble debt restructurings totaling $5.9 million, which were on accrual status. There were no trouble debt restructurings at March 31, 2010.

The following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s nonperforming assets.

 
At March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(In thousands)
 
Loans accounted for on a non-accrual basis:
                             
Commercial business
$
2,871
 
$
6,430
 
$
6,018
 
$
1,164
 
$
-
 
Other real estate mortgage
 
4,289
   
15,079
   
7,316
   
3,892
   
226
 
Real estate construction
 
4,206
   
11,826
   
12,720
   
2,124
   
-
 
Consumer
 
957
   
2,676
   
1,329
   
382
   
-
 
Total
 
12,323
   
36,011
   
27,383
   
7,562
   
226
 
Accruing loans which are contractually
past due 90 days or more
 
-
   
-
   
187
   
115
   
-
 
Total nonperforming loans
 
12,323
   
36,011
   
27,570
   
7,677
   
226
 
REO
 
27,590
   
13,325
   
14,171
   
494
   
-
 
Total nonperforming assets
$
39,913
 
$
49,336
 
$
41,741
 
$
8,171
 
$
226
 

The following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s nonperforming assets by loan type and geographical area.
 
 
 
Northwest
Oregon
   
Other
Oregon
   
Southwest
Washington
   
Other
Washington
   
Other
   
Total
March 31, 2011
(In thousands)
                                   
Commercial business
$
339
 
$
776
 
$
1,756
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
2,871
Commercial real estate
 
-
   
634
   
751
   
-
   
-
   
1,385
Land
 
-
   
-
   
1,525
   
-
   
1,379
   
2,904
Commercial construction
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
One-to-four family construction
 
2,118
   
2,088
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
4,206
Real estate one-to-four family
 
-
   
310
   
647
   
-
   
-
   
957
Total nonperforming loans
 
2,457
   
3,808
   
4,679
   
-
   
1,379
   
12,323
REO
 
4,023
   
8,657
   
11,017
   
3,893
   
-
   
27,590
Total nonperforming assets
$
6,480
 
$
12,465
 
$
15,696
 
$
3,893
 
$
1,379
 
$
39,913

In addition to the nonperforming assets set forth in the table above, at March 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had other loans of concern totaling $24.2 million and $16.2 million, respectively. Other loans of concern at March 31, 2011 consisted of sixteen loans to thirteen borrowers. Included in other loans of concern at March 31, 2011 are two real estate construction loans totaling $3.9 million (the largest of which was $3.2 million), seven commercial loans totaling $2.0 million (all of which were less than $700,000), three commercial real estate loans totaling $7.7 million (the largest of which was $7.2 million), one multifamily loan totaling $4.7 million and three land acquisition and development loan totaling $5.9 million. Other loans of concern consist of loans where the borrowers have cash flow problems, or the collateral securing the respective loans may be inadequate. In either or both of these situations, the borrowers may be unable to comply with the present loan repayment terms, and the loans may subsequently be included in the non-accrual category. Management considers the allowance for loan losses to be adequate to cover the probable losses inherent in these and other loans.


 
14 

 

At March 31, 2011, loans delinquent more than 30 days were 1.13% of total loans compared to 1.93% at March 31, 2010. At March 31, 2011, the 30 to 89 day delinquency rate in our commercial business loan portfolio was 1.65%. The 30 to 89 day delinquency rate in our commercial real estate (“CRE”) portfolio was 0.58%. CRE loans represent the largest portion of our loan portfolio at 53.04% of total loans and the commercial business loans represent 12.44% of total loans.

Asset Classification. The OTS has adopted various regulations regarding problem assets of savings institutions. The regulations require that each insured institution review and classify its assets on a regular basis.  In addition, in connection with examinations of insured institutions, OTS examiners have authority to identify problem assets and, if appropriate, require them to be classified.  There are three classifications for problem assets:  substandard, doubtful and loss (collectively “classified loans”). Substandard assets have one or more defined weaknesses and are characterized by the distinct possibility that the insured institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.  Doubtful assets have the weaknesses of substandard assets with the additional characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values questionable, and there is a high possibility of loss. An asset classified as loss is considered uncollectible and of such little value that continuance as an asset of the institution is not warranted.

When we classify problem assets as either substandard or doubtful, we may establish a specific allowance in an amount we deem prudent to address the risk specifically or we may allow the loss to be addressed in the general allowance. General allowances represent loss allowances which have been established to recognize the inherent risk associated with lending activities, but which, unlike specific allowances, have not been specifically allocated to particular problem assets. When a problem asset is classified by us as a loss, we are required to charge off the asset in the period in which it is deemed uncollectible.

The aggregate amount of the Company's classified loans, general loss allowances, specific loss allowances and charge-offs were as follows at the dates indicated:
 
 
At or For the Year
 
Ended March 31,
   
2011
   
2010
   
(In thousands)
Classified loans
$
36,389
 
$
52,245
           
General loss allowances
 
12,923
   
13,608
Specific loss allowances
 
2,045
   
8,034
Net charge-offs
 
11,749
   
11,232

All of the loans on non-accrual status as of March 31, 2011 were categorized as classified loans. Classified loans at March 31, 2011 were made up of five real estate construction loans totaling $8.1 million (the largest of which was $3.2 million), nineteen commercial business loans totaling $4.9 million (the largest of these loans totaling $670,000), seven land acquisition and development loans totaling $8.8 million (the largest of which was $3.4 million), seven one-to-four family real estate loans totaling $957,000, one multi-family loan totaling $4.7 million and seven commercial real estate loans totaling $8.9 million (the largest of which was $7.2 million). The decrease in classified loans reflects the stabilizing economic conditions and the improvements in the Company’s loan portfolio as well as transfers to REO.
 
Allowance for Loan Losses. The Company maintains an allowance for loan losses to provide for probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio. The adequacy of the allowance is evaluated monthly to maintain the allowance at levels sufficient to provide for inherent losses existing at the balance sheet date. The key components to the evaluation are the Company’s internal review function by its credit administration, which reviews and monitors the risk and quality of the loan portfolio; as well as the Company’s external loan reviews and its loan classification systems. Credit officers are expected to monitor their portfolios and make recommendations to change loan grades whenever changes are warranted. Credit administration approves any changes to loan grades and monitors loan grades. For additional discussion of the Company’s methodology for assessing the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses see Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Policies."

At March 31, 2011, the Company had an allowance for loan losses of $14.9 million, or 2.18% of total loans. The decrease in the balance of the allowance for loan losses at March 31, 2011 reflects the decreased levels of delinquent and classified loans, stabilizing economic conditions and charge-offs exceeding the provision for loan losses during the year ended March 31, 2011. Nonperforming loans decreased $23.7 million and 30-89 day delinquent loans decreased $6.4 million during the year ended March 31, 2011. Classified assets were $36.4 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $52.2 million at March 31, 2010. The decrease was primarily attributable to the slowdown in new problem loans coupled with resolutions on existing problem assets, including $7.6 million in REO sales and principal paydowns of $10.0 million. Charge-offs primarily relate to
 
 
 
15

 
 
loans that were previously considered in our analysis of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses and specifically reserved for by the Company at March 31, 2010. As a result, a corresponding increase in our allowance for loan losses was not required for these charge-offs.

Management considers the allowance for loan losses to be adequate to cover probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio based on the assessment of various factors affecting the loan portfolio and the Company believes it has established its existing allowance for loan losses in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“generally accepted accounting principles” or "GAAP"). However, a further decline in local economic conditions, results of examinations by the Company’s regulators, or other factors could result in a material increase in the allowance for loan losses and may adversely affect the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. In addition, because future events affecting borrowers and collateral cannot be predicted with certainty, there can be no assurance that the existing allowance for loan losses will be adequate or that substantial increases will not be necessary should the quality of any loans deteriorate or should collateral values further decline as a result of the factors discussed elsewhere in this document. The following table sets forth an analysis of the Company's allowance for loan losses for the periods indicated.


   
Year Ended March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 21,642     $ 16,974     $ 10,687     $ 8,653     $ 7,221  
Provision for loan losses
    5,075       15,900       16,150       2,900       1,425  
Recoveries:
                                       
Commercial and construction
                                       
Commercial business
    7       5       25       10       165  
Other real estate mortgage
    31       1       -       12       -  
Real estate construction
    7       76       -       -       -  
Total commercial and construction
    45       82       25       22       165  
Consumer
                                       
 Real estate one-to-four family
    11       7       -       -       -  
 Other installment
    2       -       2       17       28  
Total consumer
    13       7       2       17       28  
Total recoveries
    58       89       27       39       193  
Charge-offs:
                                       
Commercial and construction
                                       
Commercial business
    2,371       2,466       1,311       794       172  
Other real estate mortgage
    4,404       3,836       5,913       42       -  
Real estate construction
    4,329       3,737       2,073       -       -  
Total commercial and construction
    11,104       10,039       9,297       836       172  
Consumer
                                       
 Real estate one-to-four family
    682       1,232       361       48       -  
 Other installment
    21       50       232       21       14  
Total consumer
    703       1,282       593       69       14  
                                         
Total charge-offs
    11,807       11,321       9,890       905       186  
                                         
Net charge-offs (recoveries)
    11,749       11,232       9,863       866       (7 )
                                         
Balance at end of year
  $ 14,968     $ 21,642     $ 16,974     $ 10,687     $ 8,653  
Ratio of allowance to total loans
outstanding at end of year
    2.18 %     2.95 %     2.12 %     1.39 %     1.25 %
Ratio of net charge-offs to average net loans
    outstanding during year
    1.67       1.48       1.24       0.12       -  
Ratio of allowance to total nonperforming loans
    121.46       60.10       61.57       139.21       3,828.76  

 
16 

 

The following table sets forth the breakdown of the allowance for loan losses by loan category and is based on applying a specific loan loss factor to the outstanding balances of related loan category as of the date of the allocation for the periods indicated.

   
At March 31,
 
    2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
   
Amount
   
Loan Category
as a
Percent
of Total
Loans
   
Amount
   
Loan Category
as a
Percent
of Total
Loans
   
Amount
   
Loan Category
as a
Percent
of Total
Loans
   
Amount
   
Loan Category
as a
Percent
of Total
Loans
   
Amount
   
Loan Category
as a
Percent
of Total
Loans
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Commercial and construction:
                                                           
Commercial business
  $ 1,871       12.44 %   $ 3,181       14.76 %   $ 2,668       15.87 %   $ 1,339       14.28 %   $ 1,553       13.18 %
Other real estate mortgage
    8,870       67.19       10,028       62.52       6,475       55.88       5,415       55.97       4,066       52.19  
Real estate construction
    820       3.98       5,137       10.27       4,592       17.41       2,092       19.37       2,060       24.01  
Consumer:
                                                                               
Real estate one-to-four family
  1,294       16.06       1,522       12.10       1,148       10.46       669       9.90       333       10.10  
Other installment
    45       0.33       52       0.35       61       0.38       64       0.48       63       0.52  
Unallocated
    2,068       -       1,722       -       2,030       -       1,108       -       578       -  
Total allowance for loan loss
$ 14,968       100.00 %   $ 21,642       100.00 %   $ 16,974       100.00 %   $ 10,687       100.00 %   $ 8,653       100.00 %






 
17 

 

Investment Activities

The Board sets the investment policy of the Company. The Company's investment objectives are: to provide and maintain liquidity within regulatory guidelines; to maintain a balance of high quality, diversified investments to minimize risk; to provide collateral for pledging requirements; to serve as a balance to earnings; and to optimize returns.  The policy permits investment in various types of liquid assets permissible under OTS regulation, which includes U.S. Treasury obligations, securities of various federal agencies, "bank qualified" municipal bonds, certain certificates of deposit of insured banks, repurchase agreements, federal funds and mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”), but does not permit investment in non-investment grade bonds. The policy also dictates the criteria for classifying securities into one of three categories:  held to maturity, available for sale or trading.  At March 31, 2011, no investment securities were held for trading.  See Item 7.  “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Policies."

At March 31, 2011, the Company’s investment portfolio totaled $8.8 million, primarily consisting of $4.9 million in U.S. agency securities available-for-sale, $1.8 million in mortgage-backed securities available-for-sale, and $916,000 in trust preferred securities available-for-sale. This compares with a total investment portfolio of $10.4 million at March 31, 2010, primarily consisting of $5.0 million in U.S. agency securities available-for-sale, $2.8 million in mortgage-backed securities available-for-sale, and $1.0 million in a collateralized debt obligation (“CDO”) (secured by trust preferred securities issued by other holding companies) available-for-sale. At March 31, 2011, the Company owned no privately issued mortgage-backed securities. The Company does not believe that it has any exposure to sub-prime lending in its mortgage-backed securities portfolio. See Note 4 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for additional information.

The following table sets forth the investment securities portfolio and carrying values at the dates indicated.

   
At March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Carrying
Value
   
Percent of
Portfolio
   
Carrying
Value
   
Percent of
Portfolio
   
Carrying
Value
   
Percent of
Portfolio
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Held to maturity (at amortized cost):
                                   
REMICs
  $ -       - %   $ 53       0.51 %   $ 348       2.55 %
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
    78       0.89       86       0.83       94       0.69  
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
    112       1.27       120       1.15       128       0.94  
Municipal securities
    506       5.76       517       4.97       529       3.87  
      696       7.92       776       7.46       1,099       8.05  
Available for sale (at fair value):
                                               
Agency securities
    4,864       55.32       5,017       48.21       5,054       37.01  
REMICs
    433       4.92       556       5.34       685       5.02  
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
    1,304       14.83       2,219       21.33       3,310       24.24  
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
    40       0.45       53       0.51       71       0.52  
Municipal securities
    540       6.14       743       7.14       2,292       16.78  
Trust preferred securities
    916       10.42       1,042       10.01       1,144       8.38  
      8,097       92.08       9,630       92.54       12,556       91.95  
Total investment securities
  $ 8,793       100.00 %   $ 10,406       100.00 %   $ 13,655       100.00 %

 
18 

 

The following table sets forth the maturities and weighted average yields in the securities portfolio at March 31, 2011.

 
Less Than One Year
   
One to Five Years
   
More Than Five to Ten
Years
   
More Than
Ten Years
 
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Yield (1)
   
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Yield (1)
   
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Yield (1)
   
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Yield (1)
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Municipal securities
$
-
 
-
%
 
$
-
 
-
%
 
$
506
 
4.97
%
 
$
540
 
4.38
%
                                               
Agency securities
 
-
 
-
     
4,864
 
1.75
     
-
 
-
     
-
 
-
 
                                               
REMICs
 
-
 
-
     
-
 
-
     
147
 
5.01
     
286
 
1.41
 
FHLMC mortgage-
  backed securities
 
-
 
-
     
1,304
 
4.00
     
-
 
-
     
78
 
3.21
 
FNMA mortgage-
  backed securities
 
-
 
-
     
26
 
6.56
     
-
 
-
     
126
 
2.65
 
Trust preferred
  securities
 
-
 
-
     
-
 
-
     
-
 
-
     
916
 
8.53
 
Total
$
-
 
-
%
 
$
6,194
 
2.24
%
 
$
653
 
4.98
%
 
$
1,946
 
5.74
%

(1)    For available for sale securities carried at fair value, the weighted average yield is computed using amortized cost without a tax equivalent
adjustment for tax-exempt obligations.

Investment securities available-for-sale were $6.3 million at March 31, 2011, compared to $6.8 million at March 31, 2010. The decrease was attributable to calls, maturities, scheduled cash flows, and principal paydowns. Management reviews investment securities quarterly for the presence of other than temporary impairment (“OTTI”), taking into consideration current market conditions, the extent and nature of changes in fair value, issuer rating changes and trends, financial condition of the underlying issuers, current analysts’ evaluations, the Company’s ability and intent to hold investments until a recovery of fair value, which may be maturity, as well as other factors. The investment security that the Company recognized a non-cash impairment charge on during the years ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 is a CDO secured by trust preferred securities issued by other bank holding companies. There was no impairment charge of this security for the year ended March 31, 2011. Management believes it is possible that a substantial portion of the principal and interest will be received, that the Company does not intend to sell this security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell this security before the anticipated recovery of the remaining amortized cost basis.

At March 31, 2011, the market for the Company’s CDO was determined to be inactive in management’s judgment. This determination was made by the Company after considering the last known trade date for this specific security, the low number of transactions for similar types of securities, the significant widening of the bid-ask spread in the brokered markets in which these securities trade, the low number of new issuances for similar securities, the significant increase in the implied liquidity risk premium for similar securities, the lack of information that is released publicly and discussions with third-party industry analysts. Due to the inactivity in the market, observable market data was not readily available for all significant inputs for this security. Accordingly, the trust preferred pooled security was classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. Consistent with previous valuations, the Company determined that an income approach valuation technique (using cash flows and present value techniques) that maximizes the use of relevant observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs was the most appropriate valuation technique. Management used significant unobservable inputs that reflect our assumptions of what a market participant would use to price this security. Significant unobservable inputs included selecting an appropriate discount rate, default rate and repayment assumptions. The Company estimated the discount rate by comparing rates for similarly rated corporate bonds, with additional consideration given to market liquidity. The default rates and repayment assumptions were estimated based on the individual issuer’s financial condition, historical repayment information, as well as our future expectations of the capital markets. Using this information, the Company estimated the fair value of the security at March 31, 2011 to be $916,000.

Additionally, the Company received two independent Level 3 valuation estimates for this security. Those valuation estimates were based on proprietary pricing models utilizing significant unobservable inputs. Although the Company’s estimate of fair value fell outside the range of valuations provided, the magnitude in the range of fair value estimates further supported the difficulty in estimating the fair value for these types of securities in the current environment. Additionally, the
 
 
19

 
 
Company believes that some of the assumptions used by the independent parties were overly aggressive and unrealistic. Therefore, the Company believes its valuation at March 31, 2011 is reasonable.

In April 2009, accounting guidance was issued on the recognition and presentation of OTTI – see Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Policies." To determine the component of OTTI related to credit losses, the Company compared the amortized cost basis of the security to the present value of the revised expected cash flows, discounted using the current pre-impairment yield. The revised expected cash flow estimates were based primarily on an analysis of default rates, prepayment speeds and third-party analytical reports. In determining the expected default rates and prepayment speeds, management evaluated, among other things, the individual issuers financial condition including capital levels, nonperforming asset amounts, loan loss reserve levels, and portfolio composition and concentrations. As a result of this analysis, the Company recorded an adjustment, net of taxes, which decreased accumulated other comprehensive income with a corresponding adjustment to increase beginning retained earnings totaling $1.5 million at March 31, 2009. The Company has not made any subsequent adjustments to other comprehensive income related to OTTI.

For additional information on our Level 3 fair value measurements see Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Comparison of Financial Condition at March 31, 2011 and 2010,” “Fair Value of Level 3 Assets,” and Note 19 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of the Form 10-K.

Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds

General. Deposits, loan repayments and loan sales are the major sources of the Company's funds for lending and other investment purposes. Loan repayments are a relatively stable source of funds, while deposit inflows and outflows and loan prepayments are significantly influenced by general interest rates and money market conditions. Borrowings may be used on a short-term basis to compensate for reductions in the availability of funds from other sources. They may also be used on a longer-term basis for general business purposes.

Deposit Accounts. The Company attracts deposits from within its primary market area by offering a broad selection of deposit instruments, including demand deposits, negotiable order of withdrawal ("NOW") accounts, money market accounts, regular savings accounts, certificates of deposit and retirement savings plans. Historically, the Company has focused on retail deposits. Expansion in commercial lending has led to growth in business deposits including demand deposit accounts. Business checking accounts increased $11.6 million or 15.4% to $87.0 million at March 31, 2011 from $75.4 million at March 31, 2010. Deposit account terms vary according to the minimum balance required, the time periods the funds must remain on deposit and the interest rate, among other factors. In determining the terms of its deposit accounts, the Company considers the rates offered by its competition, profitability to the Company, matching deposit and loan products and customer preferences and concerns.

The following table sets forth the average balances of deposit accounts offered by the Company at the dates indicated.

   
Year Ended March 31,
 
    2011     2010   2009  
   
Average
Balance
   
Average
Rate
   
Average
Balance
   
Average
Rate
   
Average
Balance
   
Average
Rate
 
 
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Non-interest-bearing demand
  $ 91,167       0.00 %   $ 87,508       0.00 %   $ 81,566       0.00 %
Interest checking
    81,279       0.29       79,444       0.42       86,986       1.13  
Regular savings accounts
    34,124       0.47       29,526       0.55       27,138       0.55  
Money market accounts
    214,490       0.86       192,064       1.23       173,853       2.19  
Certificates of deposit
    287,109       1.51       277,639       2.44       282,055       3.66  
Total
  $ 708,169       0.93 %   $ 666,181       1.45 %   $ 651,598       2.34 %

Deposit accounts totaled $716.5 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $688.0 million at March 31, 2010. The continuing low interest rate environment has resulted in customers placing their deposits into money market accounts rather than certificates of deposit, permitting them to earn higher interest and maintain investment options for when interest rates increase. Money market accounts increased $26.7 million at March 31, 2011 compared to March 31, 2010.  Savings accounts increased $5.1 million compared to March 31, 2010. For additional information regarding our deposit accounts, see Note 10 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of the Form 10-K.
 
 
 
20

 
 
The Company did not have any wholesale-brokered deposits at March 31, 2011 and 2010. The Company continues to put forth a concerted effort to increase its core deposits and to focus deposit growth around customer relationships as opposed to obtaining deposits through the wholesale markets. However, the Company has continued to experience increased competition for customer deposits within its market area. Customer branch deposit balances remained constant since March 31, 2010. Overall, growth in deposits was reduced by a decrease in the average account balances of many of our real estate related customers reflecting the slowdown of home sales and the weak economic environment. Additionally, the Company had $36.6 million, or 5.1% of total deposits, in CDARS and ICS deposits, which were gathered from customers within the Company’s primary market-area. In the first quarter of fiscal 2010, the OTS informed the Company that it was placing a restriction through a Supervisory Letter Directive on the Bank’s ability to increase brokered deposits, including the Bank’s reciprocal CDARS and ICS programs, to no more than 10% of total deposits; however, as a result of the Bank’s continuing improvement in its financial condition, the OTS formally increased this limit to 20% of total deposits during March 2011.

At March 31, 2011 and 2010, deposits from RAMCorp. totaled $22.8 million and $1.9 million, respectively. These deposits were included in interest bearing and non-interest bearing accounts and represent assets under management by RAMCorp. At March 31, 2011, the Company also had $6.2 million in deposits from public entities located in the State of Washington and Oregon, all of which were fully covered by FDIC insurance or secured by pledged collateral.

During fiscal 2010, the Company enrolled in an internet deposit listing service.  Under this listing service, the Company may post time deposit rates on an internet site where institutional investors have the ability to deposit funds with the Company. At March 31, 2011, the Company had $31.6 million in deposits through this listing service. Furthermore, the Company may utilize the internet deposit listing service to purchase certificates of deposit at other financial institutions.

Deposit growth remains a key strategic focus for the Company and our ability to achieve deposit growth, particularly growth in core deposits, is subject to many risk factors including the effects of competitive pricing pressures, changing customer deposit behavior, and increasing or decreasing interest rate environments.  Adverse developments with respect to any of these risk factors could limit the Company’s ability to attract and retain deposits and could have a material negative impact on the Company’s financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

The following table presents the amount and weighted average rate of certificates of deposit equal to or greater than $100,000 at March 31, 2011.
 
Maturity Period
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average Rate
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
Three months or less
$
37,409
 
0.67
%
Over three through six months
 
29,402
 
1.14
 
Over six through 12 months
 
59,274
 
1.24
 
Over 12 Months
 
39,057
 
2.01
 
Total
$
165,142
 
1.28
%

Borrowings. Deposits are the primary source of funds for the Company's lending and investment activities and for its general business purposes.  The Company relies upon advances from the FHLB and borrowings from the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco (“FRB”) to supplement its supply of lendable funds and to meet deposit withdrawal requirements. Advances from the FHLB and borrowings from the FRB are typically secured by the Bank's commercial loans, commercial real estate loans, first mortgage loans and investment securities.

The FHLB functions as a central reserve bank providing credit for savings and loan associations and certain other member financial institutions. As a member, the Bank is required to own capital stock in the FHLB and is authorized to apply for advances on the security of such stock and certain of its mortgage loans and other assets (primarily securities which are obligations of, or guaranteed by, the United States) provided certain standards related to creditworthiness have been met.  The FHLB determines specific lines of credit for each member institution and the Bank has a line of credit with the FHLB equal to 30% of its total assets to the extent the Bank provides qualifying collateral and holds sufficient FHLB stock. At March 31, 2011, the Bank had no outstanding advances from the FHLB under an available credit facility of $247.7 million, which is limited to available collateral.

The Company also has a borrowing arrangement with the FRB with an available credit facility of $107.9 million, subject to pledged collateral, as of March 31, 2011.  At March 31, 2011, the Bank had no outstanding borrowings from the FRB.

 
21 

 

The following tables set forth certain information concerning the Company's FHLB advances and FRB borrowings at the dates and for the periods indicated.

 
At March 31,
 
   
2011
     
2010
     
2009
 
  (Dollars in thousands)  
FHLB advances outstanding
$
-
   
$
23,000
   
$
37,850
 
Weighted average rate on FHLB advances
 
-
%
   
0.64
%
   
2.02
%
                       
FRB borrowings outstanding
$
-
   
$
10,000
   
$
85,000
 
Weighted average rate on FRB advances
 
-
%
   
0.50
%
   
0.25
%


 
Year Ended March 31,
 
   
2011
     
2010
     
2009
 
  (Dollars in thousands)  
Maximum amounts of FHLB advances
  outstanding at any month end
$
28,000
   
$
23,000
   
$
144,860
 
Average FHLB advances outstanding
 
6,877
     
7,116
     
115,303
 
Weighted average rate on FHLB advances
 
0.73
%
   
1.07
%
   
1.99
%
                       
Maximum amounts of FRB borrowings
  outstanding at any month end
$
-
   
$
145,000
   
$
85,000
 
Average FRB borrowings outstanding
 
192
     
85,978
     
10,000
 
Weighted average rate on FRB borrowings
 
0.50
%
   
0.28
%
   
0.25
%
 
At March 31, 2011, the Company had two wholly-owned subsidiary grantor trusts totaling $22.7 million for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities and common securities. The trust preferred securities accrue and pay distributions periodically at specified annual rates as provided in trust agreements. The trusts used the net proceeds from each of the offerings to purchase a like amount of junior subordinated debentures (the “Debentures”) of the Company. The Debentures are the sole assets of the trusts. The Company’s obligations under the Debentures and related documents, taken together, constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the Company of the obligations of the trusts. The trust preferred securities are mandatorily redeemable upon maturity of the Debentures, or upon earlier redemption as provided in the indentures. The Company has the right to redeem the Debentures in whole or in part on or after specific dates, at a redemption price specified in the indentures governing the Debentures plus any accrued but unpaid interest to the redemption date.  The Company also has the right to defer the payment of interest on each of the Debentures for a period not to exceed 20 consecutive quarters, provided that the deferral period does not extend beyond the stated maturity. During such deferral period, distributions on the corresponding trust preferred securities will also be deferred and the Company may not pay cash dividends to the holders of shares of our common stock. Beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2011, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on its outstanding $22.7 million aggregate principal amount of Debentures and distributions on the corresponding trust preferred securities are also being deferred. The Company continued with the interest deferral at March 31, 2011. As of March 31, 2011, the Company had deferred a total of $1.3 million of interest payments. The common securities issued by the grantor trusts were purchased by the Company, and the Company’s investment in the common securities of $681,000 at March 31, 2011 and 2010 is included in prepaid expenses and other assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets included in the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of the Form 10-K. See also Note 13 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Taxation

For details regarding the Company’s taxes, see Item 8 – “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data - Note 14 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.”

Personnel

As of March 31, 2011, the Company had 238 full-time equivalent employees, none of whom are represented by a collective bargaining unit.  The Company believes its relationship with its employees is good.



 
22 

 

Corporate Information

The Company’s principal executive offices are located at 900 Washington Street, Vancouver, Washington 98660. Its telephone number is (360) 693-6650. The Company maintains a website with the address www.riverviewbank.com. The information contained on the Company’s website is not included as a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Other than an investor’s own internet access charges, the Company makes available free of charge through its website the Annual Report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to these reports, as soon as reasonably practicable after it has electronically filed such material with, or furnished such material to, the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).

Subsidiary Activities

Under OTS regulations, the Bank is authorized to invest up to 3% of its assets in subsidiary corporations, with amounts in excess of 2% only if primarily for community purposes. At March 31, 2011, the Bank’s investments of $1.1 million in Riverview Services, Inc. (“Riverview Services”), its wholly owned subsidiary, and $2.5 million in RAMCorp., an 85% owned subsidiary, were within these limitations.

Riverview Services acts as a trustee for deeds of trust on mortgage loans granted by the Bank, and receives a reconveyance fee for each deed of trust. Riverview Services had net income of $20,000 for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 and total assets of $1.1 million at that date. Riverview Services’ operations are included in the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company contained in Item 8 of the Form 10-K.

RAMCorp is an asset management company providing trust, estate planning and investment management services. RAMCorp commenced business in December 1998 and had net income of $303,000 for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 and total assets of $3.1 million at that date. RAMCorp earns fees on the management of assets held in fiduciary or agency capacity. At March 31, 2011, total assets under management totaled $328.1 million. RAMCorp’s operations are included in the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Executive Officers.  The following table sets forth certain information regarding the executive officers of the Company.

Name
Age (1)
Position
Patrick Sheaffer
71
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
Ronald A. Wysaske
58
President and Chief Operating Officer
David A. Dahlstrom
60
Executive Vice President and Chief Credit Officer
Kevin J. Lycklama
33
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
John A. Karas
62
Executive Vice President
James D. Baldovin
52
Executive Vice President Retail Banking
Kim J. Capeloto
49
Executive Vice President Marketing and Operations
(1) At March 31, 2011

Patrick Sheaffer is Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Chief Executive Officer of the Bank, positions he has held since February 2004. Prior to February 2004, Mr. Sheaffer served as Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company since its inception in 1997. He became Chairman of the Board of the Bank in 1993. Mr. Sheaffer joined the Bank in 1963. He is responsible for leadership and management of the Company. Mr. Sheaffer is active in numerous professional and civic organizations.

Ronald A. Wysaske is President and Chief Operating Officer of the Bank, positions he has held since February 2004. Prior to February 2004, Mr. Wysaske served as Executive Vice President, Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer of the Bank from 1981 to 2004 and of the Company since its inception in 1997. He joined the Bank in 1976. Mr. Wysaske is responsible for daily operations and management of the Bank. He holds an M.B.A. from Washington State University and is active in numerous professional, educational and civic organizations.

David A. Dahlstrom is Executive Vice President and Chief Credit Officer and is responsible for all Riverview lending divisions related to its commercial, mortgage and consumer loan activities.  Prior to joining Riverview in May 2002, Mr. Dahlstrom spent 14 years with First Interstate Bank and progressed through a number of management positions, including serving as Senior Vice President of the Business Banking Group in Portland.  In 1999, Mr. Dahlstrom joined a regional bank as Executive Vice President/Community Banking, responsible for all branch operations and small business banking.


 
23 

 

Kevin J. Lycklama is Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Company, positions he has held since February 2008. Prior to February 2008, Mr. Lycklama served as Vice President and Controller of the Bank since 2006. Prior to joining Riverview, Mr. Lycklama spent five years with a local public accounting firm advancing to the level of audit manager.  He is responsible for accounting, SEC reporting as well as treasury functions for the Bank and the Company. He holds a Bachelor of Arts degree from Washington State University and is a certified public accountant.

John A. Karas is Executive Vice President of the Bank and also serves as Chairman of the Board, President and CEO of its subsidiary, RAMCorp.  Mr. Karas has been employed by the Company since 1999 and has over 30 years of trust experience.  He is familiar with all phases of the trust business and his experience includes trust administration, trust legal counsel, investments and real estate. Mr. Karas received his B.A. from Willamette University and his Juris Doctor degree from Lewis & Clark Law School’s Northwestern School of Law.  He is a member of the Oregon, Multnomah County and American Bar Associations and is a Certified Trust and Financial Advisor.  Mr. Karas is also active in numerous civic organizations.

James D. Baldovin is Executive Vice President of Retail Banking and is responsible for the Bank’s branch banking network, customer service, sales and community development.  Mr. Baldovin has been employed by the Bank since January 2003 and has over 25 years of banking expertise in developing and leading sales and service cultures. He holds a Bachelor of Arts degree in economics from Linfield College and is a graduate of the Pacific Coast Banking School.

Kim J. Capeloto is Executive Vice President of Marketing and Operations. Mr. Capeloto has been employed by the Bank since September 2010. Mr. Capeloto has over 25 years of banking expertise serving as regional manager for Union Bank of California directing small business and personal banking activities. Mr. Capeloto also served as district manager for Wells Fargo Bank.  Most recently, prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Capeloto held the position of President and Chief Executive Officer of the Vancouver Chamber of Commerce. Mr. Capeloto is active in numerous professional and civic organizations in the Greater Portland Vancouver metropolitan area.

REGULATION

The following is a brief description of certain laws and regulations, which are applicable to the Company and the Bank.  The description of these laws and regulations, as well as descriptions of laws and regulations contained elsewhere herein, does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the applicable laws and regulations. Certain federal banking laws have been recently amended by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act that was enacted on July 2, 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”). See “Regulation—Dodd-Frank Act” below. Among the more significant changes made by the Dodd-Frank Act, effective July 21, 2011 (with a possible delay of up to six months) (the so-called “Designated Transfer Date”), the OTS will cease to exist as a separate entity and will be merged and become a separate division of the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”), which currently oversees national banks. The OCC will assume the OTS’s role as regulator and supervisor of the Company. In addition, beginning in 2011, all financial institution holding companies, including the Company, will be regulated by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”), including imposing federal capital requirements on the Company and may result in additional restrictions on investments and other holding company activities. The law also creates a new consumer financial protection bureau that will have the authority to promulgate rules intended to protect consumers in the financial product and services market. The creation of this independent bureau could result in new regulatory requirements and raise the cost of regulatory compliance. In addition, effective July 21, 2011, financial institutions may pay interest on demand deposits, which could increase our interest expense. We cannot determine the full impact of the new law on our business and operations at this time.

Legislation is introduced from time to time in the United States Congress (“Congress”) that may affect the Company’s and Bank’s operations.  In addition, the regulations governing the Company and the Bank may be amended from time to time by the OTS, the FDIC, the Federal Reserve or the SEC, as appropriate.  Any such legislation or regulatory changes in the future could have an adverse effect on our operations and financial condition.  We cannot predict whether any such changes may occur.

General

As a federally chartered savings institution, the Bank is subject to extensive regulation, examination and supervision by the OTS, as its primary federal regulator, and the FDIC, as the insurer of its deposits. Reference in the following discussion to the OTS should generally be read to mean the Federal Reserve or OCC, as appropriate, once the Designated Transfer Date occurs. The Bank is a member of the FHLB System and its deposit accounts are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund, which is administered by the FDIC. The Bank must file reports with the OTS and the FDIC
 
 
 
24

 
 
concerning its activities and financial condition in addition to obtaining regulatory approvals prior to entering into certain transactions such as mergers with, or acquisitions of, other financial institutions. There are periodic examinations by the OTS to evaluate the Bank’s safety and soundness and compliance with various regulatory requirements. Under certain circumstances the FDIC may also examine the Bank.  This regulatory structure is intended primarily for the protection of the insurance fund and depositors. The regulatory structure also gives the regulatory authorities extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities and examination policies, including policies with respect to the classification of assets and the establishment of adequate loan loss reserves for regulatory purposes. Any change in such policies, whether by the OTS, the FDIC or Congress, could have a material adverse impact on the Company and the Bank and their operations. The Company, as a savings and loan holding company, is required to file certain reports with, is subject to examination by, and otherwise must comply with the rules and regulations of the OTS.  The Company is also subject to the rules and regulations of the SEC under the federal securities laws.  See “-- Savings and Loan Holding Company Regulations.”

Charter Conversion. The Bank is investigating its various state and federal charter options including the possibility of converting from a federally chartered stock savings bank to a Washington chartered commercial bank and reorganizing the Company as a bank holding company. Such a conversion would be subject to the approval of the Washington Department of Financial Institutions and the Company’s reorganization as a bank holding company would be subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco.

Federal Regulation of Savings Institutions

Office of Thrift Supervision.  The OTS has extensive authority over the operations of savings institutions.  As part of this authority, the Bank is required to file periodic reports with the OTS and is subject to periodic examinations by the OTS. The OTS also has extensive enforcement authority over all savings institutions and their holding companies, including the Bank and the Company.  This enforcement authority includes, among other things, the ability to assess civil money penalties, issue cease-and-desist or removal orders and initiate prompt corrective action orders.  In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of laws and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices.  Other actions or inactions may provide the basis for enforcement action, including misleading or untimely reports filed with the OTS. Except under certain circumstances, public disclosure of final enforcement actions by the OTS is required by law.

In January 2009, the OTS finalized an informal supervisory agreement, a Memorandum of Understanding (“MOU”), which was reviewed and approved by the Board on January 21, 2009. Under that agreement, the Bank must, among other things, develop a plan for achieving and maintaining a minimum tier 1 capital (leverage) ratio of 8% and a minimum total risk-based capital ratio of 12%, compared to its current minimum required regulatory tier 1 capital (leverage) ratio of 4% and total risk-based capital ratio of 8%.  As of March 31, 2011, the Bank’s leverage ratio was 11.24% (3.24% over the required minimum) and its risk-based capital ratio was 14.61% (2.61% over the required minimum).  The MOU also requires the Bank to: (a) remain in compliance with the minimum capital ratios contained in the business plan; (b) provide notice to and obtain a non-objection from the OTS prior to the Bank declaring a dividend; (c) maintain an adequate allowance for loan and lease losses (ALLL); (d) engage an independent consultant to conduct a comprehensive evaluation of the Bank’s asset quality; (e) submit a quarterly update to its written comprehensive plan to reduce classified assets, that is acceptable to the OTS; and (f) obtain written approval of the Loan Committee and the Board prior to the extension of credit to any borrower with a classified loan.

The Company also entered into a separate MOU agreement with the OTS.  Under the agreement, the Company must, among other things support the Bank’s compliance with its MOU issued in January 2009.  The MOU also requires the Company to: (a) provide notice to and obtain written non-objection from the OTS prior to the Company declaring a dividend or redeeming any capital stock or receiving dividends or other payments from the Bank; (b) provide notice to and obtain written non-objection from the OTS prior to the Company incurring, issuing, renewing or repurchasing any new debt; and (c) submit quarterly updates to its written operations plan and consolidated capital plan.

The Board and Bank management does not believe that either of these agreements have or will constrain the Bank’s business plan and furthermore, believes that the Company and the Bank are currently in compliance with all of the requirements through its normal business operations.  These requirements will remain in effect until modified or terminated by the OTS.  For more information about the MOU and its impact on the Bank, see “Item 1A, Risk Factors – We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and/or additional regulatory actions.”
 
 
 
25

 

In addition, the investment, lending and branching authority of the Bank also are prescribed by federal laws, which prohibit the Bank from engaging in any activities not permitted by these laws. For example, no savings institution may invest in non-investment grade corporate debt securities. In addition, the permissible level of investment by federal institutions in loans secured by non-residential real property may not exceed 400% of total capital, except with approval of the OTS.  Federal savings institutions are generally authorized to branch nationwide. The Bank is in compliance with the noted restrictions.

All savings institutions are required to pay assessments to the OTS to fund the agency's operations.  The general assessments, paid on a semi-annual basis, are determined based on the savings institution's total assets, including consolidated subsidiaries.  The Bank's OTS assessment for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 was $297,000.

The Bank's general permissible lending limit for loans-to-one-borrower is equal to the greater of $500,000 or 15% of unimpaired capital and surplus (except for loans fully secured by certain readily marketable collateral, in which case this limit is increased to 25% of unimpaired capital and surplus).  At March 31, 2011, the Bank's lending limit under this restriction was $16.0 million and, at that date, the Bank’s largest lending relationship with one borrower was $10.5 million, which consisted of one commercial business loan with an outstanding balance of $2.5 million and one commercial real estate loan with an outstanding balance of $8.0 million, both of which were performing according to their original terms at March 31, 2011.

The OTS’s oversight of the Bank includes reviewing its compliance with the customer privacy requirements imposed by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (“GLBA”) and the anti-money laundering provisions of the USA Patriot Act. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley privacy requirements place limitations on the sharing of consumer financial information with unaffiliated third parties. They also require each financial institution offering financial products or services to retail customers to provide such customers with its privacy policy and with the opportunity to “opt out” of the sharing of their personal information with unaffiliated third parties. The USA Patriot Act significantly expands the responsibilities of financial institutions in preventing the use of the United States financial system to fund terrorist activities. Its anti-money laundering provisions require financial institutions operating in the United States to develop anti-money laundering compliance programs and due diligence policies and controls to ensure the detection and reporting of money laundering. These compliance programs are intended to supplement existing compliance requirements under the Bank Secrecy Act and the Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulations.

The OTS, as well as the other federal banking agencies, has adopted guidelines establishing safety and soundness standards on such matters as loan underwriting and documentation, asset quality, earnings standards, internal controls and audit systems, interest rate risk exposure and compensation and other employee benefits.  Any institution that fails to comply with these standards must submit a compliance plan.

Federal Home Loan Bank System.  The Bank is a member of the FHLB of Seattle, which is one of 12 regional FHLBs that administer the home financing credit function of savings institutions.  Each FHLB serves as a reserve or central bank for its members within its assigned region.  It is funded primarily from proceeds derived from the sale of consolidated obligations of the FHLB System.  It makes loans or advances to members in accordance with policies and procedures, established by the Board of Directors of the FHLB, which are subject to the oversight of the Federal Housing Finance Board.  All advances from the FHLB are required to be fully secured by sufficient collateral as determined by the FHLB.  In addition, all long-term advances are required to provide funds for residential home financing.  See Business – Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds – Borrowings.”

As a member, the Bank is required to purchase and maintain stock in the FHLB.  At March 31, 2011, the Bank had $7.4 million in FHLB stock, which was in compliance with this requirement. The FHLB has reported a risk-based capital deficiency under the regulations of the Federal Housing Finance Agency (“FHFA”), its primary regulator as of December 31, 2008, and stated that it would suspend future dividends and the repurchase and redemption of outstanding common stock. As a result, the FHLB has stopped paying a dividend since the fourth quarter of 2008. The Bank is continually monitoring this issue. The FHLB has communicated to its members, including us, that it believes the calculation of risk-based capital under the current rules of the FHFA significantly overstates the market and credit risk of the FHLB’s private label mortgage backed securities in the current market environment and that it has enough capital to cover the risks reflected in the FHLB’s balance sheet. As a result, the Bank has not recorded an other-than-temporary impairment on its investment in FHLB stock. However, continued deterioration in the FHLB’s financial position may result in impairment in the value of those securities, or the requirement that the Bank contribute additional funds to recapitalize the FHLB, or reduce the Bank’s ability to borrow funds from the FHLB, which may impair the Bank’s ability to meet liquidity demands. In addition, on October 25, 2010, the FHLB received a consent order from the FHFA. The potential impact of the consent order is unknown
 
 
26

 
 
at this time. We will continue to monitor the financial condition of the FHLB as it relates to, among other things, the recoverability of our investment.

The FHLBs have continued and continue to contribute to low- and moderately-priced housing programs through direct loans or interest subsidies on advances targeted for community investment and low- and moderate-income housing projects.  These contributions have in the past affected adversely the level of FHLB dividends paid and could continue to do so in the future if dividend payments resume. These contributions could also have an adverse effect on the value of FHLB stock in the future.  A reduction in value of the Bank's FHLB stock may result in a corresponding reduction in the Bank's capital.

Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  The Bank's deposits are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC and such insurance is backed by the full faith and credit of the United States Government. As insurer, the FDIC imposes deposit insurance premiums and is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require reporting by FDIC-insured institutions. Our deposit insurance premiums for the year ended March 31, 2011 were $1.6 million. Those premiums have increased due to recent strains on the FDIC deposit insurance fund due to the cost of large bank failures and increase in the number of troubled banks. On July 21, 2010, the FDIC deposit insurance coverage was permanently raised to $250,000.

The FDIC assesses deposit insurance premiums on each FDIC-insured institution quarterly based on annualized rates for four risk categories applied to its deposits, subject to certain adjustments. Each institution is assigned to one of four risk categories based on its capital, supervisory ratings and other factors. Well capitalized institutions that are financially sound with only a few minor weaknesses are assigned to Risk Category I. Risk Categories II, III and IV present progressively greater risks to the DIF. Under FDIC’s risk-based assessment rules, effective April 1, 2009 through March 31, 2011, the initial base assessment rates prior to adjustments range from 12 to 16 basis points for Risk Category I, and are 22 basis points for Risk Category II, 32 basis points for Risk Category III, and 45 basis points for Risk Category IV.  Initial base assessment rates are subject to adjustments based on an institution’s unsecured debt, secured liabilities and brokered deposits, such that the total base assessment rates after adjustments range from 7 to 24 basis points for Risk Category I, 17 to 43 basis points for Risk Category II, 27 to 58 basis points for Risk Category III, and 40 to 77.5 basis points for Risk Category IV. Rates increased uniformly by three basis points effective January 1, 2011.

As required by the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC has adopted rules effective April 1, 2011, under which insurance premium assessments are based on an institution’s total assets minus its tangible equity (defined as tier 1 capital) instead of its deposits. Under these rules, an institution with total assets of less than $10 billion will be assigned to a Risk Category as described above, and a range of initial base assessment rates will apply to each category, subject to adjustment downward based on unsecured debt issued by the institution and, except for an institution in Risk Category I, adjustment upward if the institution’s brokered deposits exceed 10% of its domestic deposits, to produce total base assessment rates. Total base assessment rates range from 2.5 to 9 basis points for Risk Category I, 9 to 24 basis points for Risk Category II, 18 to 33 basis points for Risk Category III, and 30 to 45 basis points for Risk Category IV, all subject to further adjustment upward if the institution holds more than a de minimis amount of unsecured debt issued by another FDIC-insured institution. The FDIC may increase or decrease its rates by 2.0 basis points without further rulemaking. In an emergency, the FDIC may also impose a special assessment.

In addition to the regular quarterly assessments, due to losses and projected losses attributed to failed institutions, the FDIC imposed on every insured institution a special assessment of five basis points on the amount of each depository institution’s assets reduced by the amount of its tier 1 capital (not to exceed 10 basis points of its assessment base for regularly quarterly premiums) as of June 30, 2009, which was collected on September 30, 2009. The Bank paid $417,000 for this special FDIC assessment in September 2009.

As a result of a decline in the reserve ratio (the ratio of the DIF to estimated insured deposits) and concerns about expected failure costs and available liquid assets in the DIF, the FDIC adopted a rule requiring each insured institution to prepay on December 30, 2009 the estimated amount of its quarterly assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and all quarters through the end of 2012 (in addition to the regular quarterly assessment for the third quarter which was due on December 30, 2009). The prepaid amount is recorded as an asset with a zero risk weight and the institution will continue to record quarterly expenses for deposit insurance. For purposes of calculating the prepaid amount, assessments were measured at the institution’s assessment rate as of September 30, 2009, with a uniform increase of 3 basis points effective January 1, 2011, and were based on the institution’s assessment base for the third quarter of 2009, with growth assumed quarterly at annual rate of 5%. If events cause actual assessments during the prepayment period to vary from the prepaid amount, institutions will pay excess assessments in cash or receive a rebate of prepaid amounts not exhausted after collection of assessments due on June 30, 2013, as applicable. Collection of the prepayment does not preclude the FDIC from changing assessment rates or revising the risk-based assessment system in the future. The rule includes a process for exemption from the prepayment for
 
 
27

 
institutions whose safety and soundness would be affected adversely. The Bank prepaid $5.4 million in FDIC assessments during December 2009, which will be expensed until the prepaid amount has been fully utilized. The balance of the prepaid assessment was $3.2 million at March 31, 2011.

The Dodd-Frank Act establishes 1.35% as the minimum reserve ratio. The FDIC has adopted a plan under which it will meet this ratio by September 30, 2020, the deadline imposed by the Dodd-Frank Act. The Dodd-Frank requires the FDIC to offset the effect on institutions with assets less than $10 billion of the increase in the statutory minimum reserve ratio to 1.35% from the former statutory minimum of 1.15%. The FDIC has not yet announced how it will implement this offset. In addition to the statutory minimum ratio, the FDIC must designate a reserve ratio, known as the designated reserve ratio (the “DRR”), which may exceed the statutory minimum. The FDIC has established 2.0% as the DRR. In addition, all institutions with deposits insured by the FDIC are required to pay assessments to fund interest payments on bonds issued by the Financing Corporation, an agency of the Federal government established to fund the costs of failed thrifts in the 1980’s. For the quarterly period ended December 31, 2010, the Financing Corporation assessment equaled 1.04 basis points for each $100 in domestic deposits. These assessments, which may be revised based upon the level of DIF deposits, will continue until the bonds mature in the years 2017 through 2019.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, beginning on January 1, 2011, all non-interest bearing transaction accounts and Interest on Lawyer Trust Accounts (“IOLTA”) accounts qualify for unlimited deposit insurance by the FDIC through December 31, 2012.  NOW accounts, which were previously fully insured under the Transaction Account Guarantee Program, are no longer eligible for an unlimited guarantee due to the expiration of this program on December 31, 2010.  NOW accounts, along with all other deposits maintained at the Bank are now insured by the FDIC up to $250,000 per account owner. 

In addition to the assessment for deposit insurance, institutions are required to make payments on bonds issued in the late 1980s by the Financing Corporation to recapitalize a predecessor deposit insurance fund. This payment is established quarterly and during the fiscal year ending March 31, 2011 averaged 5.33 basis points of assessable deposits. The Financing Corporation was chartered in 1987, by the OTS’ predecessor, the Federal Home Loan Bank Board solely for the purpose of functioning as a vehicle for the recapitalization of the deposit insurance system.

As insurer, the FDIC is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require reporting by FDIC-insured institutions.  It also may prohibit any FDIC-insured institution from engaging in any activity the FDIC determines by regulation or order to pose a serious threat to the DIF.  The FDIC also has the authority to take enforcement actions against banks and savings associations.

The Dodd-Frank Act contains a number of provisions that will affect the capital requirements applicable to the Company and the Bank, including the requirement that thrift holding companies be subject to consolidated capital requirements, effective on the Designated Transfer Date. In addition, on September 12, 2010, the Basel Committee adopted the Basel III capital rules. These rules, which will be phased in over a period of years, set new standards for common equity, tier 1 and total capital, determined on a risk-weighted basis. The impact on the Company and the Bank of the Basel III rules cannot be determined at this time. For additional information, see “-Capital Requirements- Possible Changes to Capital Requirements Resulting from Basel III” set forth below.

Prompt Corrective Action.  The OTS is required to take certain supervisory actions against undercapitalized savings institutions, the severity of which depends upon the institution's degree of undercapitalization.  Generally, an institution that has a ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets of less than 8%, a ratio of tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets of less than 4%, or a ratio of core capital to total assets of less than 4% (3% or less for institutions with the highest examination rating) is considered to be "undercapitalized."  An institution that has a total risk-based capital ratio less than 6%, a tier 1 capital ratio of less than 3% or a leverage ratio that is less than 3% is considered to be "significantly undercapitalized" and an institution that has a tangible capital to assets ratio equal to or less than 2% is deemed to be "critically undercapitalized."  Subject to a narrow exception, the OTS is required to appoint a receiver or conservator for a savings institution that is "critically undercapitalized."  OTS regulations also require that a capital restoration plan be filed with the OTS within 45 days of the date a savings institution receives notice that it is "undercapitalized," "significantly undercapitalized" or "critically undercapitalized." In addition, numerous mandatory supervisory actions become immediately applicable to an undercapitalized institution, including, but not limited to, increased monitoring by regulators and restrictions on growth, capital distributions and expansion.  “Significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized” institutions are subject to more extensive mandatory regulatory actions.  The OTS also could take any one of a number of discretionary supervisory actions, including the issuance of a capital directive and the replacement of senior executive officers and directors.  At March 31, 2011, the Bank’s capital ratios met the "well capitalized" standards.

 
 
28

 
Qualified Thrift Lender Test.  All savings institutions, including the Bank, are required to meet a qualified thrift lender ("QTL") test to avoid certain restrictions on their operations.  This test requires a savings institution to have at least 65% of its total assets, as defined by regulation, in qualified thrift investments on a monthly average for nine out of every 12 months on a rolling basis.  As an alternative, the savings institution may maintain 60% of its assets in those assets specified in Section 7701(a) (19) of the Internal Revenue Code ("Code").  Under either test, such assets primarily consist of residential housing related loans and investments.

A savings institution that fails to meet the QTL is subject to certain operating restrictions and may be required to convert to a national bank charter. As of March 31, 2011, the Bank did not meet the QTL test. The Bank is working to regain compliance with the QTL test by increasing its portfolio assets in qualified thrift investments. However, if the Bank elects to change charters, it will no longer be subject to the QTL test.

Capital Requirements.  Federally insured savings institutions, such as the Bank, are required by the OTS to maintain minimum levels of regulatory capital.  These minimum capital standards include: a 1.5% tangible capital to total assets ratio, a 4% leverage ratio (3% for institutions receiving the highest rating on the CAMELS examination rating system) and an 8% risk-based capital ratio. In addition, the prompt corrective action standards, discussed above, also establish, in effect, a minimum 2% tangible capital standard, a 4% leverage ratio (3% for institutions receiving the highest rating on the CAMELS system) and, together with the risk-based capital standard itself, a 4% tier 1 risk-based capital standard. The OTS regulations also require that, in meeting the tangible, leverage and risk-based capital standards, institutions must generally deduct investments in and loans to subsidiaries engaged in activities as principal that are not permissible for a national bank.

The risk-based capital standard requires federal savings institutions to maintain tier 1 (core) and total capital (which is defined as core capital and supplementary capital) to risk-weighted assets of at least 4% and 8%, respectively. In determining the amount of risk-weighted assets, all assets, including certain off-balance sheet assets, recourse obligations, residual interests and direct credit substitutes, are multiplied by a risk-weight factor of 0% to 100%, assigned by the OTS capital regulation based on the risks believed inherent in the type of asset. Tier 1 (core) capital is defined as common stockholders’ equity (including retained earnings), certain noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus and minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, less intangibles other than certain mortgage servicing rights and credit card relationships. The components of supplementary capital currently include cumulative preferred stock, long-term perpetual preferred stock, mandatory convertible securities, subordinated debt and intermediate preferred stock, the allowance for loan and lease losses limited to a maximum of 1.25% of risk-weighted assets and up to 45% of unrealized gains on available-for-sale equity securities with readily determinable fair market values. Overall, the amount of supplementary capital included as part of total capital cannot exceed 100% of core capital.

The OTS also has authority to establish individual minimum capital requirements for financial institutions. As previously discussed, in January 2009, the Bank entered into an MOU with the OTS which requires the Bank to achieve and maintain capital levels in excess of the minimum capital standards required under OTS’s Prompt Corrective Actions.  Under the MOU, the Bank must achieve and maintain tier 1 (core) leverage ratio of 8% and total risk-based capital ratio of 12%.  For additional information, see Item 1A, “Risk Factors – We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and/or additional regulatory actions” and Note 17 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Possible Changes to Capital Requirements Resulting from Basel III. In December 2010 and January 2011, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision published the final texts of reforms on capital and liquidity generally referred to as “Basel III.”  Although Basel III is intended to be implemented by participating countries for large, internationally active banks, its provisions are likely to be considered by United States banking regulators in developing new regulations applicable to other banks in the United States, including the Bank.

For banks in the United States, among the most significant provisions of Basel III concerning capital are the following:

•    
A minimum ratio of common equity to risk-weighted assets reaching 4.5%, plus an additional 2.5% as a capital conservation buffer, by 2019 after a phase-in period.

•    
A minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets reaching 6.0% by 2019 after a phase-in period.

•    
A minimum ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets, plus the additional 2.5% capital conservation buffer, reaching 10.5% by 2019 after a phase-in period.
 

 
 
29

 
•    
An additional countercyclical capital buffer to be imposed by applicable national banking regulators periodically at their discretion, with advance notice.

•    
Restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonuses applicable when capital ratios fall within the buffer zone.

•    
Deduction from common equity of deferred tax assets that depend on future profitability to be realized.

•    
Increased capital requirements for counterparty credit risk relating to OTC derivatives, repos and securities financing activities.

•    
For capital instruments issued on or after January 13, 2013 (other than common equity), a loss-absorbency requirement such that the instrument must be written off or converted to common equity if a trigger event occurs, either pursuant to applicable law or at the direction of the banking regulator.  A trigger event is an event under which the banking entity would become nonviable without the write-off or conversion, or without an injection of capital from the public sector.   The issuer must maintain authorization to issue the requisite shares of common equity if conversion were required.

The Basel III provisions on liquidity include complex criteria establishing a liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”) and net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”).  The purpose of the LCR is to ensure that a bank maintains adequate unencumbered, high quality liquid assets to meet its liquidity needs for 30 days under a severe liquidity stress scenario.  The purpose of the NSFR is to promote more medium and long-term funding of assets and activities, using a one-year horizon.  Although Basel III is described as a “final text,” it is subject to the resolution of certain issues and to further guidance and modification, as well as to adoption by United States banking regulators, including decisions as to whether and to what extent it will apply to United States banks that are not large, internationally active banks.

Limitations on Capital Distributions.  OTS regulations impose various restrictions on savings institutions with respect to their ability to make distributions of capital, which include dividends, stock redemptions or repurchases, cash-out mergers and other transactions charged to the capital account. Generally, savings institutions, such as the Bank, that before and after the proposed distribution are well-capitalized, may make capital distributions during any calendar year equal to up to 100% of net income for the year-to-date plus retained net income for the two preceding years. However, an institution deemed to be in need of more than normal supervision by the OTS, such as the Bank, may have its dividend authority restricted by the OTS. In accordance with the provisions of the MOU, the Bank may not pay dividends to the Company without prior approval of the OTS.

Generally, savings institutions proposing to make any capital distribution need not submit written notice to the OTS prior to such distribution unless they are a subsidiary of a holding company or would not remain well capitalized following the distribution.  Savings institutions that do not, or would not meet their current minimum capital requirements following a proposed capital distribution or propose to exceed these net income limitations, must obtain OTS approval prior to making such distribution.  The OTS may object to the distribution during that 30-day period based on safety and soundness concerns.  See "- Capital Requirements."

Activities of Associations and their Subsidiaries.  When a savings institution establishes or acquires a subsidiary or elects to conduct any new activity through a subsidiary that the association controls, the savings institution must file a notice or application with the FDIC and the OTS at least 30 days in advance and receive regulatory approval or non-objection.  Savings institutions also must conduct the activities of subsidiaries in accordance with existing regulations and orders.

The OTS may determine that the continuation by a savings institution of its ownership control of, or its relationship to, the subsidiary constitutes a serious risk to the safety, soundness or stability of the association or is inconsistent with sound banking practices or with the purposes of the FDIC.  Based upon that determination, the FDIC or the OTS has the authority to order the savings institution to divest itself of control of the subsidiary.  The FDIC also may determine by regulation or order that any specific activity poses a serious threat to the Deposit Insurance Fund.  If so, it may require that no FDIC insured institution engage in that activity directly.

Transactions with Affiliates. The Bank’s authority to engage in transactions with “affiliates” is limited by OTS regulations and by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board’s Regulation W. The term “affiliates” for these purposes generally means any company that controls or is under common control with an institution. The Company and its non-savings institution subsidiaries are affiliates of the Bank. In general, transactions with affiliates must be on terms that are as favorable to the institution as comparable transactions with non-affiliates. In addition, certain types of transactions are restricted to an aggregate percentage of the institution’s capital. Collateral in specified
 
 
 
30

 
 
amounts must be provided by affiliates in order to receive loans from an institution. In addition, savings institutions are prohibited from lending to any affiliate that is engaged in activities that are not permissible for bank holding companies and no savings institution may purchase the securities of any affiliate other than a subsidiary.

The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 ("Sarbanes-Oxley Act") generally prohibits a company from making loans to its executive officers and directors. However, that act contains a specific exception for loans by a depository institution to its executive officers and directors in compliance with federal banking laws. Under such laws, the Bank’s authority to extend credit to executive officers, directors and 10% stockholders of the Bank and its affiliates (“insiders”), as well as entities such persons control is limited. The law restricts both the individual and aggregate amount of loans the Bank may make to insiders based, in part, on the Bank’s capital position and requires certain Board approval procedures to be followed. Such loans must be made on terms substantially the same as those offered to unaffiliated individuals and not involve more than the normal risk of repayment. There is an exception for loans made pursuant to a benefit or compensation program that is widely available to all employees of the institution and does not give preference to insiders over other employees. There are additional restrictions applicable to loans to executive officers.

Community Reinvestment Act.  Under the Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”), every FDIC-insured institution has a continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with safe and sound banking practices to help meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low and moderate income neighborhoods. The CRA does not establish specific lending requirements or programs for financial institutions nor does it limit an institution's discretion to develop the types of products and services that it believes are best suited to its particular community, consistent with the CRA.  The CRA requires the OTS, in connection with the examination of the Bank, to assess the institution's record of meeting the credit needs of its community and to take such record into account in its evaluation of certain applications, such as a merger or the establishment of a branch, by the Bank.  An unsatisfactory rating may be used as the basis for the denial of an application by the OTS.  Due to the heightened attention being given to the CRA in the past few years, the Bank may be required to devote additional funds for investment and lending in its local community. The Bank received a satisfactory rating during its most recent examination.

Enforcement.  The OTS has primary enforcement responsibility over savings institutions and has the authority to bring action against all "institution-affiliated parties," including shareholders, and any attorneys, appraisers and accountants who knowingly or recklessly participate in wrongful action likely to have an adverse effect on an insured institution.  Formal enforcement action may range from the issuance of a capital directive or cease and desist order to removal of officers or directors, receivership, conservatorship or termination of deposit insurance.  Civil penalties cover a wide range of violations and can range from $25,000 to $1.1 million per day.  The FDIC has the authority to recommend to the Director of the OTS that enforcement action be taken with respect to a particular savings institution.  If action is not taken by the Director, the FDIC has authority to take such action under certain circumstances. Federal law also establishes criminal penalties for certain violations.

Standards for Safety and Soundness.  As required by statute, the federal banking agencies have adopted Interagency Guidelines prescribing Standards for Safety and Soundness. The guidelines set forth the safety and soundness standards that the federal banking agencies use to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions before capital becomes impaired. If the OTS determines that a savings institution fails to meet any standard prescribed by the guidelines, the OTS may require the institution to submit an acceptable plan to achieve compliance with the standard.

Federal Reserve System. The Federal Reserve Board requires all depository institutions to maintain non-interest bearing reserves at specified levels against their transaction accounts, primarily checking, NOW and Super NOW checking accounts. At March 31, 2011, the Bank was in compliance with these reserve requirements. The balances maintained to meet the reserve requirements imposed by the Federal Reserve Board may be used to satisfy any liquidity requirements that may be imposed by the OTS.

Environmental Issues Associated with Real Estate Lending.  The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act ("CERCLA"), a federal statute, generally imposes strict liability on all prior and present "owners and operators" of sites containing hazardous waste.  However, Congress asked to protect secured creditors by providing that the term "owner and operator" excludes a person whose ownership is limited to protecting its security interest in the site.  Since the enactment of the CERCLA, this "secured creditor exemption" has been the subject of judicial interpretations which have left open the possibility that lenders could be liable for cleanup costs on contaminated property that they hold as collateral for a loan.  In addition, we may be subject to environmental liabilities with respect to real estate properties that are placed in foreclosure that we subsequently take title to.

 
 
31

 
 
To the extent that legal uncertainty exists in this area, all creditors, including the Bank, that have made loans secured by properties with potential hazardous waste contamination (such as petroleum contamination) could be subject to liability for cleanup costs, which could substantially exceed the value of the collateral property.

Savings and Loan Holding Company Regulations

General.  The Company is a unitary savings and loan holding company subject to regulatory oversight of the OTS.  Accordingly, the Company is required to register and file reports with the OTS and is subject to regulation and examination by the OTS. In addition, the OTS has enforcement authority over the Company and its non-savings institution subsidiaries, which also permits the OTS to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to present a serious risk to the subsidiary savings institution.

Activities Restrictions. The GLBA provides that no company may acquire control of a savings association after May 4, 1999 unless it engages only in the financial activities permitted for financial holding companies under the law or for multiple savings and loan holding companies as described below. Further, the GLBA specifies that, subject to a grandfather provision, existing savings and loan holding companies may only engage in such activities. The Company qualifies for the grandfathering and is therefore not restricted in terms of its activities. Upon any non-supervisory acquisition by the Company of another savings association as a separate subsidiary, the Company would become a multiple savings and loan holding company and would be limited to activities permitted multiple holding companies by OTS regulation. OTS has issued an interpretation concluding that multiple savings holding companies may also engage in activities permitted for financial holding companies, including lending, trust services, insurance activities and underwriting, investment banking and real estate investments.

Mergers and Acquisitions. The Company must obtain approval from the OTS before acquiring more than 5% of the voting stock of another savings institution or savings and loan holding company or acquiring such an institution or holding company by merger, consolidation or purchase of its assets.  In evaluating an application for the Company to acquire control of a savings institution, the OTS would consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the Company and the target institution, the effect of the acquisition on the risk to the Deposit Insurance Fund, the convenience and the needs of the community and competitive factors.

The OTS may not approve any acquisition that would result in a multiple savings and loan holding company controlling savings institutions in more than one state, subject to two exceptions; (i) the approval of interstate supervisory acquisitions by savings and loan holding companies and (ii) the acquisition of a savings institution in another state if the laws of the state of the target savings institution specifically permit such acquisitions. The states vary in the extent to which they permit interstate savings and loan holding company acquisitions.
 
Acquisition of the Company. Under the Savings and Loan Holding Company Act and the Change in Bank Control Act, a notice or application must be submitted to the OTS if any person (including a company), or a group acting in concert, seeks to acquire 10% or more of the Company’s outstanding voting stock, unless the OTS has found that the acquisition will not result in a change in control of the Company. In acting on such a notice or application, the OTS must take into consideration certain factors, including the financial and managerial resources of the acquirer and the anti-trust effect of the acquisition. Any company that acquires control will be subject to regulation as a savings and loan holding company.

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.  The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (“SOX Act”) was signed into law on July 30, 2002 in response to public concerns regarding corporate accountability in connection with recent accounting scandals. The stated goals of the SOX Act are to increase corporate responsibility, to provide for enhanced penalties for accounting and auditing improprieties at publicly traded companies and to protect investors by improving the accuracy and reliability of corporate disclosures pursuant to the securities laws. The SOX Act generally applies to all companies, both U.S. and non-U.S., that file or are required to file periodic reports with the SEC under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, including the Company.

The SOX Act includes very specific additional disclosure requirements and new corporate governance rules, requires the SEC and securities exchanges to adopt extensive additional disclosure, corporate governance and related rules.  The SOX Act represents significant federal involvement in matters traditionally left to state regulatory systems, such as the regulation of the accounting profession, and to state corporate law, such as the relationship between a board of directors and management and between a board of directors and its committees.

Dodd-Frank Act.  On July 21, 2010 the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act is expected to have a broad impact on the financial services industry, including significant regulatory and compliance changes and changes to corporate governance matters affecting public companies. Many of the requirements called for in the Dodd-Frank Act will
 
 
 
32

 
 
be implemented over time and most will be subject to implementing regulations over the course of several years. Among other things, the legislation will:

(i)  
Centralizes responsibility for consumer financial protection by creating a new agency, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, with broad rulemaking, supervision and enforcement authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that would apply to all banks.

(ii)  
Apply the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies.

(iii)  
Require the federal banking regulators to seek to make their capital requirements countercyclical, so that capital requirements increase in times of economic expansion and decrease in times of economic contraction.

(iv)  
Changes the assessment base for federal deposit insurance from the amount of insured deposits to consolidated assets less tangible capital.

(v)  
Increase the minimum ratio of net worth to insured deposits of the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15% to 1.35% and require the FDIC, in setting assessments, to offset the effect of the increase on institutions with assets of less than $10 billion. As a result, this increase is expected to impose more deposit insurance cost on institutions with assets of $10 billion or more.

(vi)  
Provide new disclosure and other requirements relating to executive compensation and corporate governance and a prohibition on compensation arrangements that encourage inappropriate risks or that could provide excessive compensation.
 
(vii)  
Makes permanent the $250,000 limit for federal deposit insurance and provides unlimited federal deposit insurance until January 1, 2013, for non-interest bearing transaction accounts and IOLTA accounts at all insured depository institutions.

(viii)  
Repeals the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, thereby permitting depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts.

(ix)  
Amend the Electronic Fund Transfer Act to, among other things, give the Federal Reserve the authority to establish rules regarding interchange fees charged for electronic debit transactions by payment card issuers having assets over $10 billion and to enforce a new statutory requirement that such fees be reasonable and proportional to the actual cost of a transaction to the issuer.

(x)  
Eliminate the OTS one year from the date of the new law’s enactment and the OCC, which is currently the primary federal regulator for national banks, will become the primary federal regulator for federal thrifts, including the Company.  In addition, The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System will supervise and regulate all savings and loan holding companies that were formerly regulated by the OTS, including the Company.

Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to rulemaking and will take effect over several years, making it difficult to anticipate the overall financial impact on the Company, the Bank and the financial services industry more generally. Provisions in the legislation that affect deposit insurance assessments, and payment of interest on demand deposits could increase the costs associated with deposits. Provisions in the legislation that require revisions to the capital requirements of the Company and the Bank could require the Company and the Bank to seek additional sources of capital in the future. Based on past experience with new legislation, it can be anticipated that the Dodd-Frank Act, directly and indirectly, will significantly impact the business of the Company and the Bank and increase compliance costs.


 
33 

 

Item1A.  Risk Factors

An investment in our common stock is subject to risks inherent in our business.  Before making an investment decision, you should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below together with all of the other information included in this report.  In addition to the risks and uncertainties described below, other risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial also may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. The value or market price of our common stock could decline due to any of these identified or other risks, and you could lose all or part of your investment.  The risks below also include forward-looking statements.  This report is qualified in its entirety by these risk factors.

Financial reform legislation recently enacted by Congress will, among other things, tighten capital standards, create a new Consumer Financial Protection Bureau and result in new laws and regulations that are expected to increase our costs of operations.

On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”). This new law will significantly change the current bank regulatory structure and affect the lending, deposit, investment, trading and operating activities of financial institutions and their holding companies. The Dodd-Frank Act requires various federal agencies to adopt a broad range of new implementing rules and regulations, and to prepare numerous studies and reports for Congress. The federal agencies are given significant discretion in drafting the implementing rules and regulations, and consequently, many of the details and much of the impact of the Dodd-Frank Act may not be known for many months or years.

Among the many requirements in the Dodd-Frank Act for new banking regulations is a requirement for new capital regulations to be adopted within 18 months. These regulations must be at least as stringent as, and may call for higher levels of capital than, current regulations. Generally, trust preferred securities will no longer be eligible as tier 1 capital and outstanding TARP preferred securities will continue to qualify as tier 1 capital. In addition, the banking regulators are required to seek to make capital requirements for banks and bank holding companies, countercyclical so that capital requirements increase in times of economic expansion and decrease in times of economic contraction

Certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are expected to have a near term impact on us. For example, effective one year after the date of enactment, the Dodd-Frank Act eliminates the federal prohibitions on paying interest on demand deposits, thus allowing businesses to have interest bearing checking accounts. Depending on competitive responses, this significant change to existing law could have an adverse impact our interest expense.

The Dodd-Frank Act also broadens the base for FDIC insurance assessments. Assessments will now be based on the average consolidated total assets less tangible equity capital of a financial institution. The Dodd-Frank Act also permanently increases the maximum amount of deposit insurance for banks, savings institutions and credit unions to $250,000 per depositor and noninterest bearing transaction accounts and IOLTA accounts have unlimited deposit insurance through December 31, 2012.

The Dodd-Frank Act will require publicly traded companies to give stockholders a non-binding vote on executive compensation and so-called “golden parachute” payments and authorizes the Securities and Exchange Commission to promulgate rules that would allow stockholders to nominate their own candidates using a company’s proxy materials. The legislation also directs the federal banking regulators to issue rules prohibiting incentive compensation that encourages inappropriate risks. Specifically, the legislation directs the Federal Reserve Board to promulgate rules prohibiting excessive compensation paid to bank holding company executives, regardless of whether the company is publicly traded or not.

The Dodd-Frank Act will require Act creates a new Consumer Financial Protection Bureau with broad powers to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws. The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau has broad rule-making authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all banks and savings institutions, including the authority to prohibit “unfair, deceptive or abusive” acts and practices. The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau has examination and enforcement authority over all banks and savings institutions with more than $10 billion in assets. Financial institutions with $10 billion or less in assets, such as banks, will continue to be examined for compliance with the consumer laws by their primary bank regulators.

Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to rulemaking and will take effect over several years, making it difficult to anticipate the overall financial impact on Riverview. However, compliance with this new law and its implementing regulations will result in additional operating costs that could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
 
 
34

 
 
We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and /or additional regulatory actions.
 
In January 2009, Riverview Community Bank entered into a Memorandum of Understanding or MOU with the OTS. Under that agreement, the Bank must, among other things, develop a plan for achieving and maintaining a minimum tier 1 capital (leverage) ratio of 8% and a minimum total risk-based capital ratio of 12%, compared to its current minimum required regulatory tier 1 capital (leverage) ratio of 4% and total risk-based capital ratio of 8%. As of March 31, 2011, the Bank’s leverage ratio was 11.24% (3.24% over the new required minimum) and its risk-based capital ratio was 14.61% (2.61% over the new required minimum). The MOU also requires the Bank to:
 
·    
remain in compliance with the minimum capital ratios contained in the Bank’s business plan;

·    
provide notice to and obtain a non-objection from the OTS prior to declaring a dividend;

·    
maintain an adequate allowance for loan and lease losses;

·    
engage an independent consultant to conduct a comprehensive evaluation of the Bank’s asset quality;

·    
submit a quarterly update to its written comprehensive plan to reduce classified assets, that is acceptable to the OTS; and

·    
obtain written approval of the loan committee and the Board prior to the extension of credit to any borrower with a classified loan.

On June 9, 2009 the OTS issued a Supervisory Letter Directive or SLD to the Bank that restricts its brokered deposits (including CDARS and ICS) to 10% of total deposits. As a result of the Bank’s improving financial condition, the OTS formally increased this limit to 20% of total deposits during March 2011.  At March 31, 2011, March 31, 2010 and June 9, 2009, we did not have any wholesale-brokered deposits. The Bank participates in the CDARS product, which allows the Bank to accept deposits in excess of the FDIC insurance limit for that depositor and obtain “pass-through” insurance for the total deposit. The Bank’s CDARS and ICS balances were $36.6 million, or 5.1% of total deposits, and $31.9 million, or 4.6% of total deposits, at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
In October 2009, Riverview entered into a separate MOU with the OTS. Under this agreement, Riverview must, among other things, support the Bank’s compliance with its MOU issued in January 2009. The MOU also requires Riverview to:
 
·    
provide notice to and obtain written non-objection from the OTS prior to declaring a dividend or redeeming any capital stock or receiving dividends or other payments from the Bank;
 
·    
provide notice to and obtain written non-objection from the OTS prior to incurring, issuing, renewing or repurchasing any new debt; and
 
·    
submit to the OTS within prescribed time periods an operations plan and a consolidated capital plan that respectively addresses Riverview’s ability to meet its financial obligations through December 2012 and how the Bank will maintain capital ratios mandated by its MOU.
 
The MOUs and SLD will remain in effect until stayed, modified, terminated or suspended by the OTS.  If the OTS were to determine that Riverview or the Bank were not in compliance with their respective MOUs, it would have available various remedies, including among others, the power to enjoin "unsafe or unsound" practices, to require affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to direct an increase in capital, to restrict the growth of Riverview or the Bank, to remove officers and/or directors, and to assess civil monetary penalties. Management of Riverview and the Bank have been taking action and implementing programs to comply with the requirements of the MOU and SLD. Although compliance with the MOUs and SLD will be determined by the OTS, management believes that Riverview and the Bank have complied in all material respects with the provisions of the MOUs and SLD required to be complied with as of the date of this prospectus, including the capital requirements and restrictions on brokered deposits imposed by the OTS.  The OTS may determine, however, in its sole discretion that the issues raised by the MOUs and SLD have not been addressed satisfactorily, or that any current or past actions, violations or deficiencies could be the subject of further regulatory enforcement actions. Such enforcement actions could involve penalties or limitations on our business at Riverview or the Bank and negatively affect our ability to implement our business plan, pay dividends on or our common stock the value of our common stock as well as our financial condition and results of operations.
 
 
 
35

 

The current weak economy in the market areas we serve may continue to adversely impact our earnings and could increase the credit risk associated with our loan portfolio.

Substantially all of our loans are to businesses and individuals in the states of Washington and Oregon. A continuing decline in the economies of the seven counties in which we operate, including the Portland, Oregon metropolitan area, which we consider to be our primary market areas, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.  In particular, Washington and Oregon have experienced substantial home price declines and increased foreclosures and have experienced above average unemployment rates.

A further deterioration in economic conditions in the market areas we serve could result in the following consequences, any of which could have a materially adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations:
 
·    
loan delinquencies, problem assets and foreclosures may increase;
 
·    
demand for our products and services may decline;
 
·    
collateral for loans made may decline further in value, in turn reducing customers’ borrowing power, reducing the value of assets and collateral associated with existing loans; and
 
·    
the amount of our low-cost or non-interest bearing deposits may decrease.
 
Our real estate construction and land acquisition or development loans are based upon estimates of costs and the value of the completed project.

We make real estate construction loans to individuals and builders, primarily for the construction of residential properties. We originate these loans whether or not the collateral property underlying the loan is under contract for sale. At March 31, 2011, construction loans totaled $27.4 million, or 4.0% of our total loan portfolio, of which $18.8 million were for residential real estate projects. Approximately $2.3 million of our residential construction loans were made to finance the construction of owner-occupied homes and are structured to be converted to permanent loans at the end of the construction phase.  Land loans, which are loans made with land as security, totaled $55.3 million, or 8.0%, of our total loan portfolio at March 31, 2011. Land loans include raw land and land acquisition and development loans.  In general, construction, and land lending involves additional risks because of the inherent difficulty in estimating a property's value both before and at completion of the project as well as the estimated cost of the project.  Construction costs may exceed original estimates as a result of increased materials, labor or other costs.  In addition, because of current uncertainties in the residential real estate market, property values have become more difficult to determine than they have historically been.  Construction loans and land acquisition and development loans often involve the disbursement of funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the project and the ability of the borrower to sell or lease the property or refinance the indebtedness, rather than the ability of the borrower or guarantor to repay principal and interest.  These loans are also generally more difficult to monitor.  In addition, speculative construction loans to a builder are often associated with homes that are not pre-sold, and thus pose a greater potential risk than construction loans to individuals on their personal residences. At March 31, 2011, $71.7 million of our construction and land loans were for speculative construction loans. $7.1 million, or 9.9%, of our speculative construction and land loans were nonperforming at March 31, 2011.

Our emphasis on commercial real estate lending may expose us to increased lending risks.
 
Our current business strategy is focused on the expansion of commercial real estate lending. This type of lending activity, while potentially more profitable than single-family residential lending, is generally more sensitive to regional and local economic conditions, making loss levels more difficult to predict. Collateral evaluation and financial statement analysis in these types of loans requires a more detailed analysis at the time of loan underwriting and on an ongoing basis. In our primary market of southwest Washington and northwest Oregon, the housing market has slowed, with weaker demand for housing, higher inventory levels and longer marketing times. A further downturn in housing, or the real estate market, could increase loan delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures, and significantly impair the value of our collateral and our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure. Many of our commercial borrowers have more than one loan outstanding with us. Consequently, an adverse development with respect to one loan or one credit relationship can expose us to a significantly greater risk of loss.
 
At March 31, 2011, we had $406.7 million of commercial and multi-family real estate mortgage loans, representing 59.1% of our total loan portfolio.  These loans typically involve higher principal amounts than other types of loans, and repayment is dependent upon income generated, or expected to be generated, by the property securing the loan in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service, which may be adversely affected by changes in the economy or local market conditions. For example, if the cash flow from the borrower’s project is reduced as a result of leases not being obtained or renewed, the borrower’s ability to repay the loan may be impaired. Commercial and multi-family mortgage loans also
 
 
 
36

 
 
expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the collateral securing these loans typically cannot be sold as easily as residential real estate. In addition, many of our commercial and multi-family real estate loans are not fully amortizing and contain large balloon payments upon maturity. Such balloon payments may require the borrower to either sell or refinance the underlying property in order to make the payment, which may increase the risk of default or non-payment.

A secondary market for most types of commercial real estate and multi-family loans is not readily liquid, so we have less opportunity to mitigate credit risk by selling part or all of our interest in these loans.  As a result of these characteristics, if we foreclose on a commercial or multi-family real estate loan, our holding period for the collateral typically is longer than for one-to-four family residential mortgage loans because there are fewer potential purchasers of the collateral. Accordingly, charge-offs on commercial and multi-family real estate loans may be larger on a per loan basis than those incurred with our residential or consumer loan portfolios.

The level of our commercial real estate loan portfolio may subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny.

The FDIC, the Federal Reserve and the Office of Thrift Supervision have promulgated joint guidance on sound risk management practices for financial institutions with concentrations in commercial real estate lending. Under this guidance, a financial institution that, like us, is actively involved in commercial real estate lending should perform a risk assessment to identify concentrations. A financial institution may have a concentration in commercial real estate lending if, among other factors (i) total reported loans for construction, land development, and other land represent 100% or more of total capital, or (ii) total reported loans secured by multifamily and non-farm residential properties, loans for construction, land development and other land, and loans otherwise sensitive to the general commercial real estate market, including loans to commercial real estate related entities, represent 300% or more of total capital. The particular focus of the guidance is on exposure to commercial real estate loans that are dependent on the cash flow from the real estate held as collateral and that are likely to be at greater risk to conditions in the commercial real estate market (as opposed to real estate collateral held as a secondary source of repayment or as an abundance of caution).  The purpose of the guidance is to guide banks in developing risk management practices and capital levels commensurate with the level and nature of real estate concentrations.  The guidance states that management should employ heightened risk management practices including board and management oversight and strategic planning, development of underwriting standards, risk assessment and monitoring through market analysis and stress testing. We have concluded that we have a concentration in commercial real estate lending under the foregoing standards because our $335.3 million balance in commercial real estate loans at March 31, 2011 represents 300% or more of total capital. While we believe we have implemented policies and procedures with respect to our commercial real estate loan portfolio consistent with this guidance, bank regulators could require us to implement additional policies and procedures consistent with their interpretation of the guidance that may result in additional costs to us.

Repayment of our commercial loans is often dependent on the cash flows of the borrower, which may be unpredictable, and the collateral securing these loans may fluctuate in value.
 
At March 31, 2011, we had $85.5 million or 12.4% of total loans in commercial business loans.  Commercial lending involves risks that are different from those associated with residential and commercial real estate lending. Real estate lending is generally considered to be collateral based lending with loan amounts based on predetermined loan to collateral values and liquidation of the underlying real estate collateral being viewed as the primary source of repayment in the event of borrower default. Our commercial loans are primarily made based on the cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. The borrowers' cash flow may be unpredictable, and collateral securing these loans may fluctuate in value. Although commercial loans are often collateralized by equipment, inventory, accounts receivable, or other business assets, the liquidation of collateral in the event of default is often an insufficient source of repayment because accounts receivable may be uncollectible and inventories may be obsolete or of limited use, among other things.  Accordingly, the repayment of commercial loans depends primarily on the cash flow and credit worthiness of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower.
 
Our provision for loan losses has increased substantially and we may be required to make further increases in our provision for loan losses and to charge-off additional loans in the future, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

For the fiscal years ended March 31, 2011 and 2010 we recorded a provision for loan losses of $5.1 million and $15.9 million, respectively. We also recorded net loan charge-offs of $11.7 million and $11.2 million for the fiscal years ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. During these last two fiscal years, we experienced increasing loan delinquencies and credit losses. With the exception of residential construction and development loans, nonperforming loans and assets generally reflect unique operating difficulties for individual borrowers rather than weakness in the overall economy of the
 
 
 
37

 
 
Pacific Northwest; however, more recently the deterioration in the general economy has become a significant contributing factor to the increased levels of delinquencies and nonperforming loans. Slower sales and excess inventory in the housing market has been the primary cause of the increase in delinquencies and foreclosures for residential construction and land development loans, which represent 57.7% of our nonperforming loan balance at March 31, 2011.  At March 31, 2011 our total nonperforming assets had decreased to $39.9 million compared to $49.3 million at March 31, 2010.  Further, our portfolio is concentrated in construction and land loans and commercial and commercial real estate loans, all of which have a higher risk of loss than residential mortgage loans.
 
If current trends in the housing and real estate markets continue, we expect that we will continue to experience higher than normal delinquencies and credit losses. Moreover, until general economic conditions improve, we expect that we will continue to experience significantly higher than normal delinquencies and credit losses. As a result, we could be required to make further increases in our provision for loan losses and to charge off additional loans in the future, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
Our allowance for loan losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb losses in our loan portfolio.

Lending money is a substantial part of our business and each loan carries a certain risk that it will not be repaid in accordance with its terms or that any underlying collateral will not be sufficient to assure repayment. This risk is affected by, among other things:

·    
the cash flow of the borrower and/or the project being financed;
 
·    
changes and uncertainties as to the future value of the collateral, in the case of a collateralized loan;
 
·    
the duration of the loan;
 
·    
the credit history of a particular borrower; and
 
·    
changes in economic and industry conditions.
 
We maintain an allowance for loan losses, which is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which we believe is appropriate to provide for probable losses in our loan portfolio. The amount of this allowance is determined by management through periodic reviews and consideration of several factors, including, but not limited to:

·    
our general reserve, based on our historical default and loss experience and certain macroeconomic factors based on management’s expectations of future events; and
 
·    
our specific reserve, based on our evaluation of nonperforming loans and their underlying collateral.
 
The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires us to make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio, including the creditworthiness of our borrowers and the value of the real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the repayment of many of our loans. In determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses, we review our loans and the loss and delinquency experience, and evaluate economic conditions and make significant estimates of current credit risks and future trends, all of which may undergo material changes. If our estimates are incorrect, the allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover losses inherent in our loan portfolio, resulting in the need for additions to our allowance through an increase in the provision for loan losses.  Continuing deterioration in economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside of our control, may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses.  Our allowance for loan losses was 2.18% of gross loans held for investment and 121.46% of nonperforming loans at March 31, 2011. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require an increase in the provision for possible loan losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based on judgments different than those of management. If charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for loan losses, we will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for loan losses. Any increases in the provision for loan losses will result in a decrease in net income and may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and our capital.

If our investments in real estate are not properly valued or sufficiently reserved to cover actual losses, or if we are required to increase our valuation reserves, our earnings could be reduced.

We obtain updated valuations in the form of appraisals and broker price opinions when a loan has been foreclosed upon and the property taken in as REO, and at certain other times during the assets holding period.  Our net book value (“NBV”) in the loan at the time of foreclosure and thereafter is compared to the updated market value of the foreclosed property less estimated selling costs (fair value). A charge-off is recorded for any excess in the asset’s NBV over its fair value.  If our
 
 
 
38

 
 
valuation process is incorrect, the fair value of our investments in real estate may not be sufficient to recover our NBV in such assets, resulting in the need for additional charge-offs. Additional material charge-offs to our investments in real estate could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. In addition, bank regulators periodically review our REO and may require us to recognize further charge-offs. Any increase in our charge-offs may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

The value of the securities in our investment securities portfolio may be negatively affected by continued disruptions in securities markets.
 
The market for some of the investment securities held in our portfolio has become increasingly volatile in recent years. Volatile market conditions may detrimentally affect the value of these securities, such as through reduced valuations due to the perception of heightened credit and liquidity risks. There can be no assurance that the declines in market value associated with these disruptions will not result in other-than-temporary or permanent impairments of these assets, which would lead to accounting charges that could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Fluctuating interest rates can adversely affect our profitability.

Our profitability is dependent to a large extent upon net interest income, which is the difference, or spread, between the interest earned on loans, securities and other interest-earning assets and the interest paid on deposits, borrowings, and other interest-bearing liabilities. Because of the differences in maturities and repricing characteristics of our interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, changes in interest rates do not produce equivalent changes in interest income earned on interest-earning assets and interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities.  We principally manage interest rate risk by managing our volume and mix of our earning assets and funding liabilities. In a changing interest rate environment, we may not be able to manage this risk effectively.  Changes in interest rates also can affect: (1) our ability to originate and/or sell loans; (2) the value of our interest-earning assets, which would negatively impact shareholders’ equity, and our ability to realize gains from the sale of such assets; (3) our ability to obtain and retain deposits in competition with other available investment alternatives; and (4) the ability of our borrowers to repay adjustable or variable rate loans.  Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors, including government monetary policies, domestic and international economic and political conditions and other factors beyond our control.  If we are unable to manage interest rate risk effectively, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially harmed.
 
Our loan portfolio possesses increased risk due to our level of adjustable rate loans.
 
A substantial majority of our real estate secured loans held are adjustable-rate loans. Any rise in prevailing market interest rates may result in increased payments for borrowers who have adjustable rate mortgage loans, increasing the possibility of defaults that may adversely affect our profitability.
 
Increases in deposit insurance premiums and special FDIC assessments negatively impact our earnings.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act established 1.35% as the minimum reserve ratio. The FDIC has adopted a plan under which it will meet this ratio by the statutory deadline of September 30, 2020. The Dodd-Frank Act requires the FDIC to offset the effect on institutions with assets less than $10 billion of the increase in the minimum reserve ratio to 1.35% from the former minimum of 1.15%. The FDIC has not announced how it will implement this offset.  In addition to the statutory minimum ratio, the FDIC must set a designated reserve ratio or DRR, which may exceed the statutory minimum. The FDIC has set 2.0 as the DRR.

As required by the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC has adopted final regulations under which insurance premiums are based on an institution's total assets minus its tangible equity instead of its deposits. While our FDIC insurance premiums initially will be reduced by these regulations, it is possible that our future insurance premiums will increase under the final regulations.
 
Liquidity risk could impair our ability to fund operations and jeopardize our financial condition, growth and prospects.
 
Liquidity is essential to our business. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of loans and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. We rely on customer deposits and advances from the FHLB of Seattle (“FHLB”), borrowings from the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco ("FRB") and other borrowings to fund our operations. Although we have historically been able to replace maturing deposits and advances if desired, we may not be able to replace such funds in the future if, among other things, our financial condition, the financial condition of the FHLB or FRB, or market conditions change. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance our activities or the terms of which are acceptable could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial services industry or economy in general - such as a disruption in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for
 
 
 
39

 
 
the financial services industry in light of the recent turmoil faced by banking organizations and the continued deterioration in credit markets. Factors that could detrimentally impact our access to liquidity sources include a decrease in the level of our business activity as a result of a downturn in the Washington or Oregon markets where our loans are concentrated or adverse regulatory action against us.  In addition, the OTS has limited our ability to use brokered deposits as a source of liquidity by restricting them to not more than 20% of our total deposits.
 
Our financial flexibility will be severely constrained if we are unable to maintain our access to funding or if adequate financing is not available to accommodate future growth at acceptable interest rates. Although we consider our sources of funds adequate for our liquidity needs, we may seek additional debt in the future to achieve our long-term business objectives. Additional borrowings, if sought, may not be available to us or, if available, may not be available on reasonable terms. If additional financing sources are unavailable, or are not available on reasonable terms, our financial condition, results of operations, growth and future prospects could be materially adversely affected.  In addition, Riverview may not incur additional debt without the prior written non-objective of the OTS.  Finally, if we are required to rely more heavily on more expensive funding sources to support future growth, our revenues may not increase proportionately to cover our costs.

Decreased volumes and lower gains on sales and brokering of mortgage loans could adversely impact net income.

We originate and sell mortgage loans as well as broker mortgage loans. Changes in interest rates affect demand for our loan products and the revenue realized on the sale of loans. A decrease in the volume of loans sold/brokered can decrease our revenues and net income.
 
A general decline in economic conditions may adversely affect the fees generated by our asset management company.

To the extent our asset management clients and their assets become adversely affected by weak economic and stock market conditions, they may choose to withdraw the amount of assets managed by us and the value of their assets may decline. Our asset management revenues are based on the value of the assets we manage. If our clients withdraw assets or the value of their assets decline, the revenues generated by Riverview Asset Management Corp. will be adversely affected.

Our growth or future losses may require us to raise additional capital in the future, but that capital may not be available when it is needed or the cost of that capital may be very high.

We are required by federal regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support our operations. We anticipate that our capital resources will satisfy our capital requirements for the foreseeable future, including the heightened capital requirements under the Bank’s MOU. Nonetheless, we may elect to raise additional capital to support our business or to finance acquisitions, if any, or we may otherwise elect or be required to raise additional capital. Should we elect to raise additional capital, we may seek to do so through the issuance of, among other things, our common stock or preferred stock. The issuance of additional shares of common stock or convertible securities to new stockholders would be dilutive to our current stockholders.
 
Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and performance. Accordingly, we cannot make assurances that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed on terms that are acceptable to us, or at all. If we cannot raise additional capital when needed, our operations could be materially impaired and our financial condition and liquidity could be materially and adversely affected. In addition, if we are unable to raise additional capital when required by the OTS, we may be subject to additional adverse regulatory action.  See “We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and /or additional regulatory actions.”
 
We may experience future goodwill impairment, which could reduce our earnings.
 
We performed our annual goodwill impairment test during the quarter-ended December 31, 2010, but no impairment was identified. Our assessment of the fair value of goodwill is based on an evaluation of current purchase transactions, discounted cash flows from forecasted earnings, our current market capitalization, and a valuation of our assets. Our evaluation of the fair value of goodwill involves a substantial amount of judgment. If our judgment was incorrect and an impairment of goodwill was deemed to exist, we would be required to write down our assets resulting in a charge to earnings, which would adversely affect our results of operations, perhaps materially; however, it would have no impact on our liquidity, operations or regulatory capital.
 
New or changing tax, accounting, and regulatory rules and interpretations could significantly impact strategic initiatives, results of operations, cash flows, and financial condition.
 
The financial services industry is extensively regulated. Federal and state banking regulations are designed primarily to protect the deposit insurance funds and consumers, not to benefit a company's stockholders. These regulations may
 
 
 
40

 
 
sometimes impose significant limitations on operations. The significant federal and state banking regulations that affect us are described in this report under the heading “Item 1. Business-Regulation.”  These regulations, along with the currently existing tax, accounting, securities, insurance, and monetary laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies, and interpretations control the methods by which financial institutions conduct business, implement strategic initiatives and tax compliance, and govern financial reporting and disclosures. These laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies, and interpretations are constantly evolving and may change significantly over time.
 
Such changes could subject us to additional costs, limit the types of financial services and products we may offer, restrict mergers and acquisitions, investments, access to capital, the location of banking offices, and/or increase the ability of non-banks to offer competing financial services and products, among other things. Our success depends on our continued ability to maintain compliance with the various regulations to which we are subject. Some of these regulations may increase our costs and thus place other financial institutions in stronger, more favorable competitive positions. We cannot predict what restrictions may be imposed upon us with future legislation.
 
Provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act restricting bank interchange fees may negatively affect our revenues and earnings.
 
Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve must adopt rules regarding the interchange fees that may be charged with respect to electronic debit transactions, to take effect one year after enactment. The limits to be placed on debit interchange fees may significantly reduce Riverview Community Bank’s debit card interchange revenues. Interchange fees, or “swipe” fees, are charges that merchants pay to Riverview Community Bank and other credit card companies and card-issuing banks for processing electronic payment transactions. The Dodd-Frank Act provides the Federal Reserve with authority over interchange fees received or charged by a card issuer and requires that fees must be “reasonable and proportional” to the costs of processing such transactions. Although final rules have not yet been adopted, this provision of the Dodd-Frank Act and the applicable rules ultimately issued under the Act are expected to cause significant reductions in future card-fee revenues generated by Riverview Community Bank, while also creating meaningful compliance costs.
 
Our litigation related costs might continue to increase.
 
Riverview Community Bank is subject to a variety of legal proceedings that have arisen in the ordinary course of Riverview Community Bank’s business. In the current economic environment Riverview Community Bank’s involvement in litigation has increased significantly, primarily as a result of defaulted borrowers asserting claims in order to defeat or delay foreclosure proceedings. Riverview Community Bank believes that it has meritorious defenses in legal actions where it has been named as a defendant and is vigorously defending these suits. Although management, based on discussion with litigation counsel, believes that such proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on the financial condition or operations of Riverview Community Bank, there can be no assurance that a resolution of any such legal matters will not result in significant liability to Riverview Community Bank nor have a material adverse impact on its financial condition and results of operations or Riverview Community Bank’s ability to meet applicable regulatory requirements. Moreover, the expenses of pending legal proceedings will adversely affect Riverview Community Bank’s results of operations until they are resolved. There can be no assurance that Riverview Community Bank’s loan workout and other activities will not expose Riverview Community Bank to additional legal actions, including lender liability or environmental claims.
 
Our investment in Federal Home Loan Bank stock may become impaired.
 
At March 31, 2011, we owned $7.4 million in FHLB stock.  As a condition of membership at the FHLB, we are required to purchase and hold a certain amount of FHLB stock. Our stock purchase requirement is based, in part, upon the outstanding principal balance of advances from the FHLB and is calculated in accordance with the Capital Plan of the FHLB. Our FHLB stock has a par value of $100, is carried at cost, and it is subject to recoverability testing per applicable accounting standards. The FHLB has announced that it had a risk-based capital deficiency under the regulations of the Federal Housing Finance Agency (the "FHFA"), its primary regulator, as of December 31, 2008, and that it would suspend future dividends and the repurchase and redemption of outstanding common stock. As a result, the FHLB has not paid a dividend since the fourth quarter of 2008. The FHLB has communicated that it believes the calculation of risk-based capital under the current rules of the FHFA significantly overstates the market risk of the FHLB's private-label mortgage-backed securities in the current market environment and that it has enough capital to cover the risks reflected in its balance sheet. As a result, we have not recorded an other-than-temporary impairment on our investment in FHLB stock. However, continued deterioration in the FHLB's financial position may result in impairment in the value of those securities. We will continue to monitor the financial condition of the FHLB as it relates to, among other things, the recoverability of our investment.
 
Competition with other financial institutions could adversely affect our profitability.

The banking and financial services industry is very competitive. Legal and regulatory developments have made it easier for new and sometimes unregulated competitors to compete with us. Consolidation among financial service providers has
 
 
 
41

 
 
resulted in fewer very large national and regional banking and financial institutions holding a large accumulation of assets. These institutions generally have significantly greater resources, a wider geographic presence or greater accessibility. Our competitors sometimes are also able to offer more services, more favorable pricing or greater customer convenience than we do. In addition, our competition has grown from new banks and other financial services providers that target our existing or potential customers. As consolidation continues, we expect additional institutions to try to exploit our market.

Technological developments have allowed competitors including some non-depository institutions, to compete more effectively in local markets and have expanded the range of financial products, services and capital available to our target customers. If we are unable to implement, maintain and use such technologies effectively, we may not be able to offer products or achieve cost-efficiencies necessary to compete in our industry. In addition, some of these competitors have fewer regulatory constraints and lower cost structures.

We rely heavily on the proper functioning of our technology.

We rely heavily on communications and information systems to conduct our business.  Any failure, interruption or breach in security of these systems could result in failures or disruptions in our customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit, loan and other systems.  While we have policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of our information systems, there can be no assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed.  The occurrence of any failures, interruptions or security breaches of our information systems could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We rely on third-party service providers for much of our communications, information, operating and financial control systems technology. If any of our third-party service providers experience financial, operational or technological difficulties, or if there is any other disruption in our relationships with them, we may be required to locate alternative sources of such services, and we cannot assure that we could negotiate terms that are as favorable to us, or could obtain services with similar functionality, as found in our existing systems, without the need to expend substantial resources, if at all. Any of these circumstances could have an adverse effect on our business.

Changes in accounting standards may affect our performance.

Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations.  From time to time there are changes in the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements.  These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we report and record our financial condition and results of operations.  In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in a retrospective adjustment to prior financial statements.

An increase in interest rates, change in the programs offered by governmental sponsored entities (“GSE”) or our ability to qualify for such programs may reduce our mortgage revenues, which would negatively impact our non-interest income.

Our mortgage banking operations provide a portion of our non-interest income.  We generate mortgage revenues primarily from gains on the sale of single-family mortgage loans pursuant to programs currently offered by Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and non-GSE investors.  These entities account for a substantial portion of the secondary market in residential mortgage loans.  Any future changes in these programs, our eligibility to participate in such programs, the criteria for loans to be accepted or laws that significantly affect the activity of such entities could, in turn, materially adversely affect our results of operations.  Further, in a rising or higher interest rate environment, our originations of mortgage loans may decrease, resulting in fewer loans that are available to be sold to investors.  This would result in a decrease in mortgage banking revenues and a corresponding decrease in non-interest income.  In addition, our results of operations are affected by the amount of non-interest expense associated with mortgage banking activities, such as salaries and employee benefits, occupancy, equipment and data processing expense and other operating costs.  During periods of reduced loan demand, our results of operations may be adversely affected to the extent that we are unable to reduce expenses commensurate with the decline in loan originations.
 
We may engage in FDIC-assisted transactions, which could present additional risks to our business.

We may have opportunities to acquire the assets and liabilities of failed banks in FDIC-assisted transactions, including transactions in the states of Washington, Oregon and Idaho.  Although these FDIC-assisted transactions typically provide for FDIC assistance to an acquirer to mitigate certain risks, such as sharing exposure to loan losses and providing
 
 
 
42

 
 
indemnification against certain liabilities of the failed institution, we are (and would be in future transactions) subject to many of the same risks we would face in acquiring another bank in a negotiated transaction, including risks associated with maintaining customer relationships and failure to realize the anticipated acquisition benefits in the amounts and within the timeframes we expect.  In addition, because these acquisitions are structured in a manner that would not allow us the time and access to information normally associated with preparing for and evaluating a negotiated acquisition, we may face additional risks in FDIC-assisted transactions, including additional strain on management resources, management of problem loans, problems related to integration of personnel and operating systems and impact to our capital resources requiring us to raise additional capital.  We cannot provide assurance that we would be successful in overcoming these risks or any other problems encountered in connection with FDIC-assisted transactions.  Our inability to overcome these risks could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are dependent on key personnel and the loss of one or more of those key personnel may materially and adversely affect our prospects.

Competition for qualified employees and personnel in the banking industry is intense and there are a limited number of qualified persons with knowledge of, and experience in, the community banking industry where the Bank conducts its business. The process of recruiting personnel with the combination of skills and attributes required to carry out our strategies is often lengthy. Our success depends to a significant degree upon our ability to attract and retain qualified management, loan origination, finance, administrative, marketing and technical personnel and upon the continued contributions of our management and personnel. In particular, our success has been and continues to be highly dependent upon the abilities of key executives, including our President, and certain other employees. In addition, our success has been and continues to be highly dependent upon the services of our directors, many of whom are at or nearing retirement age, and we may not be able to identify and attract suitable candidates to replace such directors.

Our exposure to operational risks may adversely affect us.
 
Similar to other financial institutions, we are exposed to many types of operational risk, including reputational risk, legal and compliance risk, the risk of fraud or theft by employees or outsiders, the risk that sensitive customer or Company data is compromised, unauthorized transactions by employees or operational errors, including clerical or record-keeping errors. If any of these risks occur, it could result in material adverse consequences for us.

Our assets include a deferred tax asset and we may not be able to realize the full amount of such asset.

We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities based on differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and the tax bases of assets and liabilities. At March 31, 2011, the net deferred tax asset was approximately $9.4 million. The net deferred tax asset resulted mainly from loan loss provisions and REO write-downs, neither of which is currently deductible for federal income tax reporting purposes. The deferred tax asset balance at March 31, 2011 attributable to our loan loss reserves and REO write-downs was $5.4 million and $2.8 million, respectively.

We regularly review our net deferred tax assets for recoverability based on history of earnings, expectations for future earnings and expected timing of reversals of temporary differences. Realization of deferred tax assets ultimately depends on the existence of sufficient taxable income, including taxable income in prior carryback years, as well as future taxable income. We believe the recorded net deferred tax asset at March 31, 2011 is fully realizable; however, if we determine that we will be unable to realize all or part of the net deferred tax asset, we would adjust this net deferred tax asset, which would negatively impact our earnings or increase our net loss.

Regulatory and contractual restrictions may limit or prevent us from paying dividends on our common stock.

Holders of our common stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as our Board may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Furthermore, holders of our common stock are subject to the prior dividend rights of any holders of our preferred stock at any time outstanding or depositary shares representing such preferred stock then outstanding. Although we have historically declared cash dividends on our common stock, we are not required to do so. We suspended our cash dividend during the quarter ended December 31, 2008 and we do not know if we will resume the payment of dividends in the future. In addition, under the terms of the October 2009 MOU the payment of dividends by Riverview to its shareholders is subject to the prior written non-objection of the OTS.  As an entity separate and distinct from the Bank, Riverview derives substantially all of its revenue in the form of dividends from the Bank.  Accordingly, Riverview is and will be dependent upon dividends from the Bank to satisfy its cash needs and to pay dividends on its common stock and service the interest payments on its trust preferred security. The inability to receive dividends from the Bank could have a material adverse effect on Riverview’s business, financial condition and results of operations. The Bank’s ability to pay dividends is subject to its ability to earn net income and, to meet certain regulatory requirements. The Bank
 
 
 
43

 
 
does not currently meet these regulatory requirements. As discussed above, under its January 2009 MOU, the Bank may not pay dividends to Riverview without prior notice to the OTS, which also limits Riverview’s ability to pay dividends on its common stock. The lack of a cash dividend could adversely affect the market price of our common stock.
 
We have deferred payments of interest on our outstanding junior subordinated debentures and as a result we are prohibited from declaring or paying dividends or distributions on, and from making liquidation payments with respect to, our common stock.

In the first quarter of fiscal 2011, we elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on our outstanding $22.7 million aggregate principal amount of junior subordinated debentures issued in connection with the sale of trust preferred securities through statutory business trusts. There are currently two separate series of these junior subordinated debentures outstanding, each series having been issued under a separate indenture and with a separate guarantee from Riverview. During the deferral period, interest will continue to accrue on the junior subordinated debentures at the stated coupon rate, including the deferred interest, and Riverview may not, among other things, pay cash dividends on or, with limited exceptions, repurchase its common stock nor make any payment on outstanding debt obligations that rank equally with or are junior to the junior subordinated debentures.

We may, without notice to or consent from the holders of our common stock, issue additional series of junior subordinated debentures in the future with terms similar to those of our existing junior subordinated debentures or enter into other financing agreements that limit our ability to purchase or to pay dividends or distributions on our capital stock, including our common stock. Under Riverview’s MOU the issuance of any new debt is subject to the non-objection of the OTS. Assuming we were to receive such non-objection, as a result of our deferral of interest on the junior subordinated debentures, it is likely that we will not be able to raise funds through the offering of debt securities until we become current on these obligations or these obligations are restructured. 
 
This deferral may also adversely affect our ability to obtain debt financing on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. In addition, if Riverview defers interest payments on the junior subordinated debentures for more than 20 consecutive quarters, it would be in default under the indentures governing these debentures and the amount due under such agreements would be immediately due and payable. Events of default under the indenture generally consist of our failure to pay interest on the junior subordinated debt securities under certain circumstances, our failure to pay any principal of or premium on such junior subordinated debt securities when due, our failure to comply with certain covenants under the indenture, and certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or liquidation relating to us or the Bank.
 
As long as we defer interest payments, we will likely have greater difficulty in obtaining financing and have fewer financing sources. In addition, the market value of our common stock may be adversely affected.
 
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

Item 2.  Properties

The executive offices of the Company are located in downtown Vancouver, Washington at 900 Washington Street.   The Company’s operational center, opened in 2006, is also located in Vancouver, Washington (both offices are leased).  At March 31, 2011, the Bank had 10 offices located in Clark County (five of which are leased), one office in Cowlitz County, two offices in Klickitat County, and one office in Skamania County.  The Bank also had two offices in Multnomah County (one of which is leased), and one office in Marion County.  During fiscal year March 31, 2010, the Company sold two of its branches and immediately entered into lease agreements for both locations.

Item 3.  Legal Proceedings

Periodically, there have been various claims and lawsuits involving the Company, such as claims to enforce liens, condemnation proceedings on properties in which the Company holds security interests, claims involving the making and servicing of real property loans and other issues incident to the Company’s business.  The Company is not a party to any pending legal proceedings that it believes would have a material adverse effect on the financial condition, results of operations or liquidity of the Company.

Item 4.  [Removed and Reserved]


 
44 

 

PART II

Item 5.   Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

At March 31, 2011, there were 22,471,890 shares of Company common stock issued and outstanding, 827 stockholders of record and an estimated 2,296 holders in nominee or “street name.” Under Washington law, the Company is prohibited from paying a dividend if, as a result of its payment, the Company would be unable to pay its debts as they become due in the normal course of business, or if the Company’s total liabilities would exceed its total assets. The principal source of funds for the Company is dividend payments from the Bank. OTS regulations require the Bank to give the OTS 30 days advance notice of any proposed declaration of dividends to the Company, and the OTS has the authority under its supervisory powers to prohibit the payment of dividends to the Company. The OTS imposes certain limitations on the payment of dividends from the Bank to the Company, which utilize a three-tiered approach that permits various levels of distributions based primarily upon a savings association’s capital level. In addition, the Bank is required to provide notice to and receive the non-objection of the OTS prior to declaring a dividend pursuant to the terms of an MOU. See Item 1A, “Risk Factors – We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and /or additional regulatory actions” and Item 1, “Regulation – Federal Regulation of Savings Associations – Limitations on Capital Distributions.” In addition, the Company may not declare or pay a cash dividend on its capital stock if the effect thereof would be to reduce the regulatory capital of the Bank below the amount required for the liquidation account established pursuant to the Bank’s conversion from the mutual stock form of organization. See Note 1 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

The common stock of the Company is traded on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under the symbol “RVSB”.  The following table sets forth the high and low trading prices, as reported by Nasdaq, and cash dividends paid for each quarter during 2011 and 2010 fiscal years.  At March 31, 2011, there were 22 market makers in the Company’s common stock as reported by the Nasdaq Global Select Market.
 
Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2011
 
High
   
Low
   
Cash
Dividends
Declared
                 
Quarter ended March 31, 2011
$
3.21
 
$
2.69
 
$
-
Quarter ended December 31, 2010
 
2.80
   
2.00
   
-
Quarter ended September 30, 2010
 
2.49
   
1.73
   
-
Quarter ended June 30, 2010
 
3.81
   
2.24
   
-

Fiscal Year Ended March 31, 2010
 
High
   
Low
   
Cash
Dividends
Declared
                 
Quarter ended March 31, 2010
$
2.94
 
$
2.21
 
$
-
Quarter ended December 31, 2009
 
3.93
   
2.24
   
-
Quarter ended September 30, 2009
 
4.32
   
2.95
   
-
Quarter ended June 30, 2009
 
3.90
   
2.63
   
-

Stock Repurchase

Shares are repurchased from time-to-time in open market transactions.  The timing, volume and price of purchases are made at our discretion, and are also contingent upon our overall financial condition, as well as general market conditions.
 
The Company did not repurchase any shares of common stock for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 or 2009.

Securities for Equity Compensation Plans

Please refer to Item 12 in this Form 10-K for a listing of securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans.

 
45 

 

 
 
COMPARISON OF 5 YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN*
Among Riverview Bancorp, Inc., the S&P 500 Index
and the NASDAQ Bank Index
 
     
   
 
 
   
3/31/06*
3/31/07
3/31/08
3/31/09
3/31/10
3/31/11
               
Riverview Bancorp, Inc.
 
100.00
122.45
79.27
31.32
18.61
24.60
S & P 500
 
100.00
111.83
106.15
65.72
98.43
113.83
NASDAQ Bank
 
100.00
101.19
80.28
48.67
64.45
64.85

*$100 invested on 3/31/06 in stock or index-including reinvestment of dividends

Copyright © 2011, Standard & Poor's, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. All rights reserved.
www.researchdatagroup.com/S&P.htm

 
46 

 

Item 6.   Selected Financial Data

The following condensed consolidated statements of operations and financial condition and selected performance ratios as of March 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for the years then ended have been derived from the Company’s audited Consolidated Financial Statements. The information below is qualified in its entirety by the detailed information included elsewhere herein and should be read along with Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Item 8. “Financial Statement and Supplementary Data” included in this Form 10-K.

 
At March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(In thousands)
 
FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA:
                             
                                         
Total assets
  $ 859,263     $ 837,953     $ 914,333     $ 886,849     $ 820,348  
Loans receivable, net
    672,609       712,837       784,117       756,538       682,951  
Loans held for sale
    173       255       1,332       -       -  
Mortgage-backed securities held
to maturity
    190       259       570       885       1,232  
Mortgage-backed securities available
for sale
    1,777       2,828       4,066       5,338       6,640  
Cash and interest-bearing deposits
    51,752       13,587       19,199       36,439       31,423  
Investment securities held to maturity
    506       517       529       -       -  
Investment securities available for
sale
    6,320       6,802       8,490       7,487       19,267  
Deposit accounts
    716,530       688,048       670,066       667,000       665,405  
FHLB advances
    -       23,000       37,850       92,850       35,050  
Federal Reserve Bank advances
    -       10,000       85,000       -       -  
Shareholders’ equity
    106,944       83,934       88,663       92,585       100,209  
                                         
 
Year Ended March 31,
 
      2011       2010       2009       2008       2007  
   
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
 
OPERATING DATA:
                                       
                                         
Interest income
  $ 43,214     $ 46,262     $ 52,850     $ 60,682     $ 61,300  
Interest expense
    8,052       11,376       19,183       25,730       24,782  
Net interest income
    35,162       34,886       33,667       34,952       36,518  
Provision for loan losses
    5,075       15,900       16,150       2,900       1,425  
Net interest income after provision
for loan losses
    30,087       18,986       17,517       32,052       35,093  
Gains from sale of loans,
securities and real estate owned
    779       1,032       729       368       434  
Impairment on investment security
    -       (1,003 )     (3,414 )     -       -  
Other non-interest income
    7,110       7,237       8,215       8,514       8,600  
Non-interest expenses
    31,496       34,973       27,259       27,791       26,353  
    Income (loss) before income taxes
    6,480       (8,721 )     (4,212 )     13,143       17,774  
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
    2,165       (3,277 )     (1,562 )     4,499       6,168  
Net income (loss)
  $ 4,315     $ (5,444 )   $ (2,650 )   $ 8,644     $ 11,606  
Earnings per share:                              
Basic
  $ 0.24     $ (0.51 )   $ (0.25 )   $ 0.79     $ 1.03  
Diluted
    0.24       (0.51 )     (0.25 )     0.79       1.01  
Dividends per share
    -       -       0.135       0.42       0.395  



 
47

 




   
At or For the Year Ended March 31,
 
    2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  
                               
KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS:
                             
Performance Ratios:
                             
Return (loss) on average assets
    0.51 %     (0.62 )%     (0.29 )%     1.04 %     1.43 %
Return (loss) on average equity
    4.29       (6.00 )     (2.85 )     8.92       11.88  
Dividend payout ratio (1)
    -       -       (54.00 )     53.16       38.35  
Interest rate spread
    4.46       4.19       3.73       4.09       4.37  
Net interest margin
    4.64       4.39       4.08       4.66       5.01  
Non-interest expense to average assets
    3.70       3.97       3.02       3.34       3.24  
Efficiency ratio (2)
    73.16       82.97       69.54       63.40       57.85  
                                         
Asset Quality Ratios:
                                       
Average interest-earning assets
to interest-bearing liabilities
    116.86       114.21       114.85       116.75       118.96  
Allowance for loan losses to
total net loans at end of period
    2.18       2.95       2.12       1.39       1.25  
Allowance for loan losses to
   nonperforming loans
    121.46       60.10       61.57       139.21       3,828.76  
Net charge-offs to average outstanding
loans during the period
    1.67       1.48       1.24       0.12       -  
Ratio of nonperforming assets
to total assets
    4.65       5.89       4.57       0.92       0.03  
Ratio of nonperforming loans
to total loans
    1.79       4.90       3.44       1.00       0.03  
                                         
Capital Ratios:
                                       
Total capital to risk-weighted assets
    14.61       12.11       11.46       10.99       11.38  
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets
    13.35       10.85       10.21       9.78       10.22  
Leverage ratio
    11.24       9.84       9.50       9.29       9.60  

(1)  
Dividends per share divided by earnings (loss) per share
(2)  
Non-interest expense divided by the sum of net interest income and non-interest income

 
48 

 

Item 7.   Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

General

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is intended to assist in understanding the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.  The information contained in this section should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and accompanying Notes thereto contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K and the other sections contained in this Form 10-K.

Critical Accounting Policies

The Company has established various accounting policies that govern the application of accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America in the preparation of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.  The Company has identified policies that due to judgments, estimates and assumptions inherent in those policies are critical to an understanding of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.  These policies relate to the methodology for the determination of the allowance for loan losses, the valuation of investment securities, the valuation of real estate owned (“REO”) and foreclosed assets, goodwill valuation and the calculation of income taxes.  These policies and the judgments, estimates and assumptions are described in greater detail in subsequent sections of Management’s Discussions and Analysis contained herein and in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.  In particular, Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies,” describes generally the Company’s accounting policies.  Management believes that the judgments, estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements are appropriate given the factual circumstances at the time.  However, given the sensitivity of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements to these critical accounting policies, the use of other judgments, estimates and assumptions could result in material differences in the Company’s results of operations or financial condition.

Allowance for Loan Losses
The allowance for loan losses is maintained at a level sufficient to provide for probable loan losses based on evaluating known and inherent risks in the loan portfolio. The allowance is provided based upon management’s ongoing quarterly assessment of the pertinent factors underlying the quality of the loan portfolio. These factors include changes in the size and composition of the loan portfolio, delinquency levels, actual loan loss experience, current economic conditions, and detailed analysis of individual loans for which full collectibility may not be assured.  The detailed analysis includes techniques to estimate the fair value of loan collateral and the existence of potential alternative sources of repayment. The allowance consists of specific, general and unallocated components. The specific component relates to loans that are considered impaired. For such loans that are classified as impaired, an allowance is established when the net realizable value of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan. The general component covers non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses. Such factors include uncertainties in economic conditions, uncertainties in identifying triggering events that directly correlate to subsequent loss rates, changes in appraised value of underlying collateral, risk factors that have not yet manifested themselves in loss allocation factors and historical loss experience data that may not precisely correspond to the current portfolio or economic conditions.  The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio. The appropriate allowance level is estimated based upon factors and trends identified by management at the time the consolidated financial statements are prepared.

When available information confirms that specific loans or portions thereof are uncollectible, identified amounts are charged against the allowance for loan losses. The existence of some or all of the following criteria will generally confirm that a loss has been incurred: the loan is significantly delinquent and the borrower has not demonstrated the ability or intent to bring the loan current; the Bank has no recourse to the borrower, or if it does, the borrower has insufficient assets to pay the debt; the estimated fair value of the loan collateral is significantly below the current loan balance, and there is little or no near-term prospect for improvement.

A loan is considered impaired when it is probable that a creditor will be unable to collect all amounts (principal and interest) due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Typically, factors used in determining if a loan is impaired are, but not limited to: if the loan is 90 days or more delinquent, internally designated as substandard, on non-accrual status or a trouble debt restructure. The majority of the Company’s impaired loans are considered collateral dependent. When a loan is considered collateral dependent, impairment is measured using the estimated value of the underlying collateral, less any prior liens, and estimated selling costs. For impaired loans that are not collateral dependent impairment is measured using
 
 
 
49

 
 
the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. When the net realizable value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan (including accrued interest, net deferred loan fees or costs, and unamortized premium or discount), an impairment is recognized by adjusting an allocation of the allowance for loan losses. Subsequent to the initial allocation of allowance to the individual loan the Company may conclude that it is appropriate to record a charge-off of the impaired portion of the loan. When a charge-off is recorded the loan balance is reduced and the specific allowance is eliminated. Generally, when a collateral dependent loan is initially measured for impairment and does not have an appraisal performed in the last three months, the Company obtains an updated market valuation. Subsequently, the Company obtains an updated market valuation on an annual basis. The valuation may occur more frequently if the Company determines that there is an indication that the market value may have declined.

Investment Valuation
Investment securities are classified as held to maturity when the Company has the ability and positive intent to hold such securities to maturity. Investment securities held to maturity are carried at amortized cost. Unrealized losses due to fluctuations in fair value are recognized when it is determined that a credit related other than temporary decline in value has occurred. Investment securities bought and held principally for the purpose of sale in the near term are classified as trading securities. Securities that the Company intends to hold for an indefinite period, but not necessarily to maturity are classified as available for sale. Securities available for sale are reported at fair value. Unrealized gains and losses, net of the related deferred tax effect, are reported as a net amount in a separate component of shareholders’ equity entitled “accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).” Realized gains and losses on securities available for sale, determined using the specific identification method, are included in earnings.  Premiums and discounts are amortized using the interest method over the period to maturity or expected call, if sooner.

Unrealized losses on available for sale and held to maturity securities are evaluated at least quarterly to determine whether the declines in value should be considered other than temporary.  OTTI is separated into a credit and noncredit component.  Noncredit component losses are recorded in other comprehensive income (loss) when the Company a) does not intend to sell the security or b) is not more likely than not to have to sell the security prior to the security’s anticipated recovery. Credit component losses are reported through earnings. To determine the component of OTTI related to credit losses, the Company compares the amortized cost basis of the OTTI security to the present value of the revised expected cash flows, discounted using the current pre-impairment yield. Significant judgment of management is required in this analysis that includes, but is not limited to, assumptions regarding the ultimate collectibility of principal and interest on the underlying collateral.

Although the determination of whether an impairment is other-than-temporary involves significant judgment, the underlying principle used is based on positive evidence indicating that an investment’s carrying value is recoverable within a reasonable period of time outweighs negative evidence to the contrary.  Evidence that is objectively determinable and verifiable is given greater weight than evidence that is subjective and or not verifiable. Evidence based on future events will generally be less objective as it is based on future expectations and therefore is generally less verifiable or not verifiable at all.  Factors considered in evaluating whether a decline in value is other-than-temporary include, (a) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost, (b) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer and (c) the Company’s intent and ability to retain the investment for a period of time. Other factors that may be considered include the ratings by recognized rating agencies; capital strength and other near-term prospects of the issuer and recommendation of investment advisors or market analysts.  In situations in which the security’s fair value is below amortized cost but it continues to be probable that all contractual terms of the security will be satisfied, the decline is solely attributable to noncredit factors, and the Company asserts that it has positive intent and ability to hold that security to maturity, no OTTI is recognized.

Valuation of REO and Foreclosed Assets
Real estate properties acquired through foreclosure or by deed-in-lieu of foreclosure are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value less estimated costs to sell. Fair value is generally determined by management based on a number of factors, including third-party appraisals of fair value in an orderly sale. Accordingly, the valuation of REO is subject to significant external and internal judgment. Any differences between management’s assessment of fair value, less estimated costs to sell, and the carrying value of the loan at the date a particular property is transferred into REO are charged to the allowance for loan losses. Management periodically reviews REO values to determine whether the property continues to be carried at the lower of its recorded book value or fair value, net of estimated costs to sell. Any further decreases in the value of REO are considered valuation adjustments and trigger a corresponding charge to non-interest expense in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. Expenses from the maintenance and operations of REO are included in other non-interest expense.


 
50 

 

Goodwill Valuation
Goodwill is initially recorded when the purchase price paid for an acquisition exceeds the estimated fair value of the net identified tangible and intangible assets acquired. Goodwill is presumed to have an indefinite useful life and is tested, at least annually, for impairment at the reporting unit level. The Company has one reporting unit, the Bank, for purposes of computing goodwill. All of the Company’s goodwill has been allocated to this single reporting unit. The Company performs an annual review in the third quarter of each year, or more frequently if indications of potential impairment exist, to determine if the recorded goodwill is impaired. If the fair value exceeds the carrying value, goodwill at the reporting unit level is not considered impaired and no additional analysis is necessary. If the carrying value of the reporting unit is higher than its fair value, there is an indication that impairment may exist and additional analysis must be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. The amount of impairment is determined by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to the carrying value of the goodwill in the same manner as if the reporting unit was being acquired in a business combination. Specifically, the Company would allocate the fair value to all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit, including unrecognized intangible assets, in a hypothetical analysis that would calculate the implied fair value of goodwill. If the implied fair value of goodwill is less than the recorded goodwill, the Company would record an impairment charge for the difference.

A significant amount of judgment is involved in determining if an indicator of impairment has occurred. Such indicators may include, among others; a significant decline in our expected future cash flows; a sustained, significant decline in our stock price and market capitalization; a significant adverse change in legal factors or in the business climate; adverse action or assessment by a regulator; and unanticipated competition. Any adverse change in these factors could have a significant impact on the recoverability of these assets and could have a material impact on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

Income taxes
The Company estimates tax expense based on the amount it expects to owe various tax authorities.  Accrued taxes represent the net estimated amount due or to be received from taxing authorities.  In estimating accrued taxes, management assesses the relative merits and risks of the appropriate tax treatment of transactions taking into account statutory, judicial and regulatory guidance in the context of our tax position.  For additional information see Note 1 and Note 14 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements and New Accounting Pronouncements

See Note 1 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for a description of recently adopted and new accounting pronouncements, including the respective dates of adoption and expected effects on the Company’s financial position and results of operations.

Operating Strategy

Fiscal year 2011 marked the 88th anniversary since the Bank began operations in 1923.  The historical emphasis had been on residential real estate lending. Since 1998, however, the Company has been diversifying its loan portfolio through the expansion of its commercial and construction loan portfolios. At March 31, 2011, commercial and construction loans represented 83.6% of total loans. Commercial lending including commercial real estate has higher credit risk, greater interest margins and shorter terms than residential lending which can increase the loan portfolio’s profitability.

The primary business strategy of the Company is to provide comprehensive banking and related financial services within its local communities. The Company’s growing commercial customer base has enjoyed new products and the improvements in existing products. These new products include business checking, internet banking, remote deposit capture, expanded cash management services, bankcard merchant services, CDARS and ICS deposit offerings and new loan products including loans targeted to medical professionals. Retail customers have benefited from expanded choices ranging from additional automated teller machines, consumer lending products, checking accounts, debit cards, 24 hour account information service and internet banking.

During 2008, the national and regional residential lending market experienced a notable slowdown. This downturn, which has continued into 2011, has negatively affected the economy in our market area. As a result, the Company experienced a decline in the values of real estate collateral supporting its construction real estate and land acquisition and development loans, and experienced increased loan delinquencies and defaults. In response to these financial challenges, the Company has taken and is continuing to take a number of actions aimed at preserving existing capital, reducing lending concentrations and associated capital requirements, and increasing liquidity. The tactical actions taken include, but are not limited to: focusing on reducing the amount of nonperforming assets, adjusting the balance sheet by reducing loan receivables, selling real estate
 
 
51

 
 
owned, reducing controllable operating costs, increasing retail deposits while maintaining available secured borrowing facilities to improve liquidity and eliminating dividends to shareholders. In addition, during fiscal 2011, the Company raised additional capital of $18.8 million in net proceeds through an underwritten public offering of its common stock.
 
The Company’s goal is to deliver returns to shareholders by managing problem assets, increasing higher-yielding assets (in particular commercial real estate and commercial loans), increasing core deposit balances, reducing expenses, hiring experienced employees with a commercial lending focus and exploring opportunistic acquisitions. The Company seeks to achieve these results by focusing on the following objectives:
 
Focusing on Asset Quality. The Company is focused on monitoring existing performing loans, resolving nonperforming loans and selling foreclosed assets. The Company has aggressively sought to reduce its level of nonperforming assets through write-downs, collections, modifications and sales of nonperforming loans and real estate owned. The Company has taken proactive steps to resolve its nonperforming loans, including negotiating repayment plans, forbearances, loan modifications and loan extensions with borrowers when appropriate, and accepting short payoffs on delinquent loans, particularly when such payoffs result in a smaller loss than foreclosure. Beginning in 2008, in connection with the downturn in real estate markets, the Company applied more conservative and stringent underwriting practices to new loans, including, among other things, increasing the amount of required collateral or equity requirements, reducing loan-to-value ratios and increasing debt service coverage ratios. During the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011, nonperforming assets decreased from $49.3 million at March 31, 2010 to $39.9 million at March 31, 2011. Likewise, nonperforming loans decreased from $36.0 million at March 31, 2010 to $12.3 million at March 31, 2011. The Company has continued to reduce its exposure to land development and speculative construction loans which represented $7.1 million or 57.7% of its nonperforming loans at March 31, 2011 as compared to $23.9 million or 66.0% of its nonperforming loans at March 31, 2010. The total land development and speculative construction loan portfolios declined to $71.7 million compared to $105.4 million a year ago.
 
Improving Earnings by Expanding Product Offerings. The Company intends to prudently increase the percentage of its assets consisting of higher-yielding commercial real estate and commercial loans, which offer higher risk-adjusted returns, shorter maturities and more sensitivity to interest rate fluctuations.  The Company also intends to selectively add additional products to further diversify revenue sources and to capture more of each customer’s banking relationship by cross selling loan and deposit products and additional services to Bank customers, including services provided through RAMCorp to increase its fee income. Assets under management by RAMCorp. totaled $328.1 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $279.5 million at March 31, 2010.
 
Attracting Core Deposits and Other Deposit Products. The Company’s strategic focus is to emphasize total relationship banking with its customers to internally fund its loan growth.  The Company is also focused on reducing its reliance on other wholesale funding sources, including FHLB and FRB advances, through the continued growth of core customer deposits. The Company believes that a continued focus on customer relationships will help to increase the level of core deposits and locally-based retail certificates of deposit.  In addition to its retail branches, the Company maintains state of the art technology-based products, such as personal financial management, business cash management, and business remote deposit products, that enable it to compete effectively with banks of all sizes. Branch deposits have remained constant during the past fiscal year, however, advances from the FHLB and FRB decreased from $33.0 million at March 31, 2010 to none at March 31, 2011.
 
Recruiting and Retaining Highly Competent Personnel with a Focus on Commercial Lending. The Company’s ability to continue to attract and retain banking professionals with strong community relationships and significant knowledge of its markets will be a key to its success. The Company believes that it enhances its market position and adds profitable growth opportunities by focusing on hiring and retaining experienced bankers focused on owner occupied commercial real estate and commercial lending, and the deposit balances that accompany these relationships. The Company emphasizes to its employees the importance of delivering exemplary customer service and seeking opportunities to build further relationships with its customers. The goal is to compete with other financial service providers by relying on the strength of the Company’s customer service and relationship banking approach. The Company believes that one of its strengths is that its employees are also shareholders through the Company’s employee stock ownership (“ESOP”) and 401(k) plans.  The Company also offers an incentive system that is designed to reward well-balanced and high quality growth amongst its employees. During fiscal year 2011, the Company hired additional talented and experienced bankers, including an executive vice president of operations and marketing, director of medical banking and two additional commercial bankers. Management believes the addition of these professionals will allow the Company to capitalize on growth opportunities in the coming fiscal year.

Disciplined Franchise Expansion.  The Company believes that opportunities currently exist within its current market area to grow its franchise.  The Company anticipates organic growth, through its marketing efforts targeted to take advantage of
 
 
 
52

 
 
the opportunities being created as a result of the consolidation of financial institutions that is occurring in its market area.  The Company will also seek to grow its franchise through the acquisition of individual branches and FDIC-assisted whole bank transactions that meet its investment and market objectives.  The Company has a proven ability to execute acquisitions, with two bank acquisitions in the past seven years.  The Company expects to gradually expand its operations further in the Portland, Oregon metropolitan area which has a population of approximately two million people.  The Company will continue to be disciplined as it pertains to future acquisitions and de novo branching focusing on the Pacific Northwest markets it knows and understands. The Company currently has no arrangements, agreements or understandings related to any acquisition or de novo branching.

Comparison of Financial Condition at March 31, 2011 and 2010

At March 31, 2011, the Company had total assets of $859.3 million compared with $838.0 million at March 31, 2010.  The increase in total assets was part of the Company’s strategic plan to improve the Company’s liquidity position by increasing cash and short-term investments.

Cash, including interest-earning accounts, totaled $51.8 million at March 31, 2011, compared to $13.6 million at March 31, 2010.  The $38.2 million increase was attributable to the Company’s planned balance sheet restructuring strategy and the Company’s decision to increase its liquidity position for regulatory and asset-liability purposes. As a part of this strategy, beginning in fiscal year 2011, the Company began investing in short-term certificates of deposit.  At March 31, 2011, certificates of deposits held for investments totaled $14.9 million. The increase in cash was also attributable to the increase in deposit balances and the decline in loans receivable during this period. Additionally, the $18.8 million raised in the Company’s common stock offering resulted in an increase in cash balances.

Investment securities available-for-sale totaled $6.3 million at March 31, 2011, compared to $6.8 million at March 31, 2010.  The $482,000 decrease was attributable to called securities, principal paydowns and fair market value adjustments. During the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011, the Company had no OTTI charges on investment securities compared to a $1.0 million OTTI charge in the prior fiscal year. For additional information on our Level 3 fair value measurements see “-Fair Value of Level 3 Assets”.

Mortgage-backed securities available-for-sale totaled $1.8 million at March 31, 2011, compared to $2.8 million at March 31, 2010.  The $1.0 million decrease was a result of principal repayments. The Company does not believe it has any exposure to sub-prime mortgage-backed securities.

Loans receivable, net, was $672.6 million at March 31, 2011, compared to $712.8 million at March 31, 2010, a 5.6% decrease due primarily to continuing weak loan demand in the Company’s primary market area and the Company’s planned balance sheet restructuring strategy, which included reducing the loan portfolio to preserve capital and liquidity. This reduction was accomplished primarily through a decrease in the land acquisition and development and residential construction loan portfolios, which were reduced $36.2 million since March 31, 2010. The balances in the commercial construction and commercial business loan portfolios also decreased by $31.4 million and $22.9 million, respectively, since March 31, 2010. The decline in the loan portfolio was a result of a combination of loan payoffs, principal repayments, a reduced emphasis on lending in certain sectors of the loan portfolio as new loan production was curtailed due to the weak economy and reduced demand from creditworthy borrowers, transfer of loans to REO and loan charge-offs. The Company’s strategy concerning future loan growth is focused on commercial business loans, owner occupied commercial real estate loans and certain high quality one-to-four family mortgage loans. A substantial portion of the loan portfolio is secured by real estate, either as primary or secondary collateral, located in the Company’s primary market area.  Risks associated with loans secured by real estate include decreasing land and property values, material increases in interest rates, deterioration in local economic conditions, tightening credit or refinancing markets, and a concentration of loans within any one area.  The Company has no option adjustable-rate mortgage (ARM), teaser, or sub-prime residential real estate loans in its portfolio.

Prepaid expenses and other assets were $5.9 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $7.9 million at March 31, 2010. The decrease was primarily due to the amortization of prepaid FDIC insurance premiums of $1.5 million.  The Bank prepaid FDIC insurance assessments for the calendar years 2010, 2011 and 2012.

Goodwill was $25.6 million at March 31, 2011 and 2010.  The Company performed its annual goodwill impairment test during the third quarter ended December 31, 2010.  The results of these tests indicated that the Company’s goodwill was not impaired.  For additional information on our goodwill impairment testing, see "Goodwill Valuation" included in this Item 7.

Deposit accounts totaled $716.5 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $688.0 million at March 31, 2010. Core branch deposits (comprised of all demand, savings, interest checking accounts, time deposits, excluding, Trust account deposits,
 
 
53

 
 
IOLTA, public funds and internet-based deposits) account for 91.1% of total deposits at March 31, 2011, compared to 94.8% at March 31, 2010. The decrease in the percentage of core branch deposits was primarily a result of an increase in Trust deposit accounts by $20.9 million. At March 31, 2011 and 2010, there were no brokered deposits (exclusive of CDARS and ICS deposits). The Company plans to continue its focus on the growth of customer branch deposits and on building customer relationships as opposed to obtaining deposits through the wholesale markets.

The Bank did not have any FRB or FHLB advances at March 31, 2011 compared to $10.0 million and $23.0 million, respectively, at March 31, 2010. The $33.0 million decrease in total borrowings was attributable to the Company’s increase in deposit balances, planned decrease in loan balances and additional funds resulting from the completion of its common stock offering.

Shareholders' equity increased $23.0 million to $106.9 million at March 31, 2011 from $83.9 million at March 31, 2010. The increase in equity was primarily a result of the $18.8 million in net proceeds from the common stock offering and net income of $4.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2011.

Goodwill Valuation

Goodwill is initially recorded when the purchase price paid for an acquisition exceeds the estimated fair value of the net identified tangible and intangible assets acquired. Goodwill is presumed to have an indefinite useful life and is tested, at least annually, for impairment at the reporting unit level. The Company has one reporting unit, the Bank, for purposes of computing goodwill. All of the Company’s goodwill has been allocated to this single reporting unit. The Company performs an annual review in the third quarter of each fiscal year, or more frequently if indications of potential impairment exist, to determine if the recorded goodwill is impaired. If the fair value exceeds the carrying value, goodwill at the reporting unit level is not considered impaired and no additional analysis is necessary.  If the carrying value of the reporting unit is higher than its fair value, there is an indication that impairment may exist and additional analysis must be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. The amount of impairment is determined by comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to the carrying value of the goodwill in the same manner as if the reporting unit was being acquired in a business combination. Specifically, the Company would allocate the fair value to all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit, including unrecognized intangible assets, in a hypothetical analysis that would calculate the implied fair value of goodwill. If the implied fair value of goodwill is less than the recorded goodwill, the Company would record an impairment charge for the difference.

A significant amount of judgment is involved in determining if an indicator of impairment has occurred. Such indicators may include, among others; a significant decline in expected future cash flows; a sustained, significant decline in our stock price and market capitalization; a significant adverse change in legal factors or in the business climate; adverse assessment or action by a regulator; and unanticipated competition. Any adverse change in these factors could have a significant impact on the recoverability of such assets and could have a material impact on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company performed its annual goodwill impairment test during the quarter-ended December 31, 2010. The goodwill impairment test involves a two-step process. Step one of the goodwill impairment test estimates the fair value of the reporting unit utilizing the allocation of corporate value approach, the income approach and the market approach in order to derive an enterprise value of the Company. The allocation of corporate value approach applies the aggregate market value of the Company and divides it among the reporting units. A key assumption in this approach is the control premium applied to the aggregate market value. A control premium is utilized as the value of a company from the perspective of a controlling interest is generally higher than the widely quoted market price per share. The Company used an expected control premium of 30%, which was based on comparable transactional history. The income approach uses a reporting unit’s projection of estimated operating results and cash flows that is discounted using a rate that reflects current market conditions. The projection uses management’s best estimates of economic and market conditions over the projected period including growth rates in loans and deposits, estimates of future expected changes in net interest margins and cash expenditures. Assumptions used by the Company in its discounted cash flow model (income approach) included an annual revenue growth rate that approximated 5%, a net interest margin that approximated 4.5% and a return on assets that ranged from 0.63% to 1.13% (average of 0.93%). In addition to utilizing the above projections of estimated operating results, key assumptions used to determine the fair value estimate under the income approach was the discount rate of 14.1% utilized for our cash flow estimates and a terminal value estimated at 1.0 times the ending book value of the reporting unit. The Company used a build-up approach in developing the discount rate that included: an assessment of the risk free interest rate, the rate of return expected from publicly traded stocks, the industry the Company operates in and the size of the Company. The market approach estimates fair value by applying cash flow multiples to the reporting unit’s operating performance. The multiples are derived from comparable publicly traded companies with similar operating and investment characteristics of the
 
 
54

 
 
reporting unit. In applying the market approach method, the Company selected eight publicly traded comparable institutions based on a variety of financial metrics (tangible equity, leverage ratio, return on assets, return on equity, net interest margin, nonperforming assets, net charge-offs, and reserves for loan losses) and other relevant qualitative factors (geographical location, lines of business, business model, risk profile, availability of financial information, etc.). After selecting comparable institutions, the Company derived the fair value of the reporting unit by completing a comparative analysis of the relationship between their financial metrics listed above and their market values utilizing various market multiples. The Company calculated a fair value of its reporting unit of $78 million using the corporate value approach, $89 million using the income approach and $81 million using the market approach. The results of the Company’s step one test indicated that the reporting unit’s fair value was less than its carrying value and therefore the Company performed a step two analysis.

The Company calculated the implied fair value of its reporting unit under step two of the goodwill impairment test. Under this approach, the Company calculated the fair value for its unrecognized deposit intangible, as well as the remaining assets and liabilities of the reporting unit. The calculated implied fair value of the Company’s goodwill exceeded the carrying value by $55.0 million. Significant adjustments were made to the fair value of the Company’s loans receivable compared to its recorded value. The Company used two separate methods to determine the fair value of its loans receivable. For performing and noncriticized loans, the Company utilized a discounted cash flow approach. For nonperforming and criticized loans, the Company utilized a comparable transaction approach using comparable loan sales. A key assumption used by the Company under each method was determining an appropriate discount rate. For the discounted cash flow approach the Company started with its contractual cash flows and its current lending rate for comparable loans and adjusted these for both credit and liquidity premiums. For the comparable transaction approach a weighted average discount rate was used that approximated the discount for similar loan sales by the FDIC. Based on results of the step two impairment test, the Company determined no impairment charge of goodwill was required.

An interim impairment test was not deemed necessary as of March 31, 2011, due to there not being a significant change in the reporting unit’s assets and liabilities, the amount that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeded the carrying value as of the most recent valuation, and because the Company determined that, based on an analysis of events that have occurred and circumstances that have changed since the most recent valuation date, the likelihood that a current fair value determination would be less than the current carrying amount of the reporting unit is remote.

Even though the Company determined that there was no goodwill impairment during the third quarter of fiscal 2011, continued declines in the value of its stock price as well as values of other financial institutions, declines in revenue for the Company beyond our current forecasts and significant adverse changes in the operating environment for the financial industry may result in a future impairment charge.

It is possible that changes in circumstances existing at the measurement date or at other times in the future, or in the numerous estimates associated with management’s judgments, assumptions and estimates made in assessing the fair value of our goodwill, could result in an impairment charge of a portion or all of our goodwill. If the Company recorded an impairment charge, its financial position and results of operations would be adversely affected, however, such an impairment charge would have no impact on our liquidity, operations or regulatory capital.

Fair Value of Level 3 Assets

The Company determines the fair value of certain assets that are classified as Level 3 under the fair value hierarchy established by accounting standards. These Level 3 assets are valued using significant unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the assets. These Level 3 assets include certain available for sale securities, loans measured for impairment, and REO for which there is neither an active market for identical assets from which to determine fair value, nor is there sufficient, current market information about similar assets to use as observable, corroborated data for all significant inputs in a valuation model. Under these circumstances, the fair values of these assets are determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies, appraisals, valuation in accordance with accounting standards, for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation.
 
Valuations using models or other techniques are dependent upon assumptions used for the significant inputs.  Where market data is available, the inputs used for valuation reflect that information as of the valuation date. In periods of extreme volatility, lessened liquidity or in illiquid markets, there may be more variability in market pricing or a lack of market data to use in the valuation process.  Judgment is then applied in formulating those inputs.

At March 31, 2011, the market for the Company’s CDO was determined to be inactive in management’s judgment. This determination was made by the Company after considering the last known trade date for this specific security, the low
 
 
55

 
 
number of transactions for similar types of securities, the significant widening of the bid-ask spread in the brokered markets in which these securities trade, the low number of new issuances for similar securities, the significant increase in the implied liquidity risk premium for similar securities, the lack of information that is released publicly and discussions with third-party industry analysts. Due to the inactivity in the market, observable market data was not readily available for all significant inputs for this security. Accordingly, the trust preferred pooled security was classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. Consistent with previous valuations, the Company determined that an income approach valuation technique (using cash flows and present value techniques) that maximizes the use of relevant observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs was the most appropriate valuation technique. Management used significant unobservable inputs that reflect our assumptions of what a market participant would use to price this security. Significant unobservable inputs included selecting an appropriate discount rate, default rate and repayment assumptions. The Company estimated the discount rate by comparing rates for similarly rated corporate bonds, with additional consideration given to market liquidity. The default rates and repayment assumptions were estimated based on the individual issuer’s financial conditions, historical repayment information, as well as our future expectations of the capital markets. The reasonableness of the fair value, and classification as a Level 3 asset, was validated through comparison of fair value as determined by two independent third-party pricing services.

Additionally, the Company received two independent Level 3 valuation estimates for this security. Those valuation estimates were based on proprietary pricing models utilizing significant unobservable inputs.  Although the Company’s estimate of fair value fell outside the range of valuations provided, the magnitude in the range of fair value estimates further supported the difficulty in estimating the fair value for these types of securities in the current environment.  Additionally, the Company believes that some of the assumptions used were overly aggressive and unrealistic. Therefore, the Company believes its valuation at March 31, 2011 is reasonable.

Certain loans included in the loan portfolio were deemed impaired at March 31, 2011.  Accordingly, loans measured for impairment were classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy as there is no active market for these loans.  Measuring impairment of a loan requires judgment and estimates, and the eventual outcomes may differ from those estimates.  Impairment was measured based on a number of factors, including recent independent appraisals which are further reduced for estimated selling costs or as a practical expedient by estimating the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate.

In addition, REO was classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.  Management generally determines fair value based on a number of factors, including third-party appraisals of fair value less estimated costs to sell.  The valuation of REO is subject to significant external and internal judgment, and the eventual outcomes may differ from those estimates.

For additional information on our Level 1, 2 and 3 fair value measurements see Note 19 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended March 31, 2011 and 2010

Net Income or Loss.  Net income was $4.3 million, or $0.24 per diluted share for the year ended March 31, 2011, compared to a net loss of $5.4 million, or $0.51 per diluted share for the year ended March 31, 2010. The increase in earnings reflects the current stabilization of the economic environment, which contributed to the significant decreases in the provision for loan losses and costs associated with REO properties compared to the prior year.

Net Interest Income.  The Company’s profitability depends primarily on its net interest income, which is the difference between the income it receives on interest-earning assets and the interest paid on deposits and borrowings. When interest-earning assets equal or exceed interest-bearing liabilities, any positive interest rate spread will generate net interest income. The Company’s results of operations are also significantly affected by general economic and competitive conditions, particularly changes in market interest rates, government legislation and regulation, and monetary and fiscal policies.

Net interest income for fiscal year 2011 was relatively unchanged at $35.2 million, representing a $276,000, or a 0.79% increase, from $34.9 million in fiscal year 2010.  The net interest margin for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 was 4.64% compared to 4.39% for the same prior year period. This increase was primarily the result of a decrease in the Company’s deposit and borrowing costs.

The ratio of average interest-earning assets to average interest-bearing liabilities increased to 116.86% for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 compared to 114.21% for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010, which indicates that the interest-earning asset growth was being funded more by capital and non-interest-bearing demand deposits as compared to interest-bearing liabilities. Generally, the Company’s balance sheet interest rate sensitivity achieves better net interest rate margins in
 
 
56

 
 
a stable or increasing interest rate environment due to the balance sheet being slightly asset interest rate sensitive.  However, due to a significant number of loans in the loan portfolio with interest rate floors, net interest income will be negatively impacted in a rising interest rate environment until such time as the current rate exceeds these interest rate floors. During the year ended March 31, 2011, the Company made progress in reducing its deposit and borrowing costs resulting in improved net interest margin. While we do not anticipate further significant reductions in market interest rates, we do expect some further modest reductions in deposit costs due to our deposit offering rates and as existing long term deposits renew upon maturity and reprice to a lower rate. The amount and timing of these reductions is dependent on competitive pricing pressures, the relationship of short term and long term interest rates and changes in interest rate spreads.

Interest Income.  Interest income was $43.2 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 compared to $46.3 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010. The decrease in interest income was due primarily to the decrease in the average balance of loans receivable. Average interest-bearing assets decreased $37.3 million to $758.8 million for fiscal year 2011 from $796.2 million for fiscal year 2010. The decrease in average loan balances was due to the Company’s efforts to realign its balance sheet and reduce its loan portfolio as part of the Company’s capital and liquidity strategy. The yield on interest-earning assets was 5.70% for fiscal year 2011 compared to 5.82% for fiscal year 2010. During the years ended March 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company reversed $216,000 and $757,000, respectively, of interest income on nonperforming loans. Other interest and dividend income increased $130,000 to $210,000 for fiscal year 2011 compared to $80,000 for fiscal year 2010. This increase was primarily due to the increase in short-term certificates of deposit during fiscal year 2011, which generated interest income of $111,000 that was not present during fiscal year 2010.

Interest Expense.  Interest expense for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 totaled $8.1 million, a $3.3 million or 29.2% decrease from $11.4 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010. The decrease in interest expense was the result of declining deposit costs, primarily due to certificates of deposit repricing at lower current rates, and reduced borrowing costs attributable to the repayment of our FHLB and FRB borrowings. The Company has continued to lower its deposit costs throughout the year on many of its deposit products. The weighted average interest rate on interest-bearing deposits decreased from 1.67% for the year ended March 31, 2010 to 1.06% for the year ended March 31, 2011.  The weighted average interest rate of FHLB borrowings decreased from 1.07% for the year ended March 31, 2010 to 0.73% for the year ended March 31, 2011. Average borrowings from the FHLB and FRB decreased from $93.1 million during fiscal year 2010 to $7.1 million during fiscal year 2011. The Company’s FHLB borrowings were fully paid off during August 2010 while the Company’s FRB borrowings were paid off in April 2010.

Provision for Loan Losses. The provision for loan losses for fiscal year 2011 was $5.1 million, compared to $15.9 million for the same period in the prior year. The decrease in the provision for loan losses was primarily a result of a decrease in the level of delinquent and classified loans compared to prior year as well as the stabilizing economic conditions. Recent appraisals received by the Company have reflected a stabilization in real estate values and less severe declines in land development projects. However, despite these improvements, the provision for loan losses continues to reflect higher levels of classified loans, delinquencies, nonperforming loans and net charge-offs compared to historical experiences. These conditions are primarily the result of a slowdown in residential real estate sales that affected among others, homebuilders and developers. This slowdown in home sales coupled with declining real estate values has significantly affected these borrowers’ liquidity and ability to repay loans. The Company’s problem loans continue to be concentrated in land acquisition and development loans.

Net charge-offs for the year ended March 31, 2011 were $11.7 million, compared to $11.2 million for the same period last year. The net charge-offs were primarily attributable to the charge-off of land and lot loans totaling $4.1 million, speculative construction loans totaling $4.3 million and commercial business loans totaling $2.4 million for the year ended March 31, 2011. Net charge-offs to average net loans for the year ended March 31, 2011 were 1.67%, compared to 1.48% for the same period last year. Net charge-offs exceeded the provision for loan losses for the year ended March 31, 2011, which resulted in the overall decrease in the allowance for loan losses compared to the prior year. Charge-offs primarily relate to loans that were previously considered in our analysis of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses and specifically reserved for by the Company at March 31, 2010. As a result, a corresponding increase in our allowance for loan losses was not required for these charge-offs. Nonperforming loans decreased to $12.3 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $36.0 million at March 31, 2010. The ratio of allowance for loan losses to total loans was 2.18% at March 31, 2011, compared to 2.95% at March 31, 2010.  The allowance as a percentage of nonperforming loans increased to 121.5% at March 31, 2011, compared to 60.1% at March 31, 2010. This ratio increased due to the overall decrease in nonperforming loans.

Impaired loans are subjected to an impairment analysis to determine an appropriate reserve amount to be held against each loan. As of March 31, 2011, the Company had identified $27.4 million of impaired loans. Because the significant majority of our impaired loans are collateral dependent, nearly all of our specific allowances are calculated based on the fair value of the
 
 
57

 
 
collateral. Of those impaired loans, $8.7 million have no specific valuation allowance as their estimated collateral value is equal to or exceeds the carrying costs, which in some cases is the result of previous loan charge-offs. The remaining $18.7 million have specific valuation allowances totaling $2.0 million. Based on its comprehensive analysis, management deemed the allowance for loan losses of $15.0 million at March 31, 2011 (2.18% of total loans and 121.46% of nonperforming loans) adequate to cover probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio. See Note 6 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for additional information regarding the allowance for loan losses.

Non-Interest Income.  Non-interest income increased $623,000 to $7.9 million for the year ended March 31, 2011 from $7.3 million for the same period in 2010. The increase in non-interest income was primarily due to a $1.0 million OTTI charge on a pooled trust preferred security taken for the year ended March 31, 2010 while there was no similar OTTI charge for the year ended March 31, 2011. Gain on sale of loans held for sale decreased $494,000 for the year ended March 31, 2011 compared to the same period in prior year. The decrease was due to the decrease in real estate loan sales activity the Company experienced during fiscal year 2011 compared to fiscal year 2010 as homeowners took advantage of the historically low interest rates and government incentives during fiscal year 2010. The decrease was also attributable to the Company’s decision to hold single-family residential mortgage loans in its portfolio as opposed to selling these loans to FHLMC. Broker loan fees decreased by $533,000 in fiscal year 2011 compared to the year ended March 31, 2010 primarily as a result the slowdown in real estate loan sales. These decreases were offset by asset management fees which increased $194,000 for the year ended March 31, 2011 compared to the same prior year period. The increase in asset management fees was a result of the increase in assets under management of RAMCorp., which totaled $279.5 million at March 31, 2010 compared to $328.1 million at March 31, 2011.

Non-Interest Expense.  Non-interest expense decreased $3.5 million to $31.5 million for fiscal year ended March 31, 2011 compared to $35.0 million for fiscal year ended March 31, 2010. Management continues to focus on managing controllable costs as the Company proactively adjusts to lower levels of real estate lending activity. However, certain expenses remain out of the Company’s control, including FDIC insurance premiums and REO expenses and write-downs. Additionally, the Company has increased certain expenses including salaries and employee benefits and advertising expenses as the Company has hired several new professionals to position the Company for future growth opportunities and also resumed some employee incentive programs. The Company has increased the number of full-time equivalent employees from 233 at March 31, 2010 to 238 at March 31, 2011.

The principal component of the decrease in the Company’s non-interest expense was due to the decrease in REO related expenses (which includes operating costs, write-downs and losses on the disposition of property) of $4.6 million. REO related expense will remain elevated compared to historical levels due to the higher REO balances as compared to previous years.

The Company’s FDIC deposit insurance premiums were $1.6 million for the year ended March 31, 2011, compared to $1.9 million for same prior year period. The decrease was a result of a $417,000 special assessment paid in fiscal year 2010. The FDIC insurance premiums are higher than historical amounts as a result of an industry wide increase in FDIC insurance premiums.

Income Taxes.  The provision for income taxes was $2.2 million for the year ended March 31, 2011 compared to a benefit for income taxes of $3.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2010.  The effective tax rate for fiscal year 2011 was 33.4% compared to 37.6% for fiscal year 2010. When the Company incurs a pre-tax loss, its effective tax rate is higher than the statutory tax rate primarily as a result of non-taxable income generated from investments in bank owned life insurance and tax-exempt municipal bonds. Reference is made to Note 14 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K, for further discussion of the Company’s income taxes.

Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended March 31, 2010 and 2009

Net Income or Loss.  Net loss was $5.4 million, or $0.51 per diluted earning share for the year ended March 31, 2010, compared to a net loss of $2.7 million, or $0.25 per diluted share for the year ended March 31, 2009. The decrease in earnings was a result of the deterioration in economic conditions including a downturn in the housing markets and a decline in real estate values. These conditions resulted in an increase in the provision for loan losses, an increase in FDIC insurance premiums and an increase in cost associated with REO properties.

Net Interest Income.  Net interest income for fiscal year 2010 was $34.9 million, representing a $1.2 million, or a 3.6% increase, from $33.7 million in fiscal year 2009.  The net interest margin for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010 was 4.39% compared to 4.08% for the same prior year period. This increase was primarily the result of a decrease in the Company’s deposit and borrowing costs.
 
 
58

 

Interest Income.  Interest income was $46.3 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010 compared to $52.9 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2009. The 12.5% decrease in interest income was due to the low interest rate environment and a decrease in the average balance of loans receivable. The yield on interest-earning assets was 5.82% for fiscal year 2010 compared to 6.39% for fiscal year 2009.  During the year ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company reversed $757,000 and $854,000, respectively, of interest income on nonperforming loans. Average interest-bearing assets decreased $31.6 million to $796.2 million for fiscal year 2010 from $827.7 million for fiscal year 2009. The decrease in average loan balances was due to the Company’s efforts to realign its balance sheet and reduce its overall loans receivable as part of the Company’s capital and liquidity strategy. Other interest and dividend income decreased $132,000 to $80,000 for fiscal year 2010 compared to $212,000 for fiscal year 2009. This decrease was primarily due to a reduction in the yield on daily interest-bearing assets to 0.10% for fiscal year 2010 compared to 1.17% for fiscal year 2009. The decrease in the yield for such assets was primarily due to interest rate cuts from the Federal Reserve.

Interest Expense.  Interest expense for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2010 totaled $11.4 million, a $7.8 million or 40.70% decrease from $19.2 million for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2009. The decrease in interest expense was the result of declining deposit and borrowing costs attributable to the low interest rate environment. The weighted average interest rate on interest-bearing deposits decreased from 2.68% for the year ended March 31, 2009 to 1.67% for the year ended March 31, 2010.  The weighted average interest rate of FHLB borrowings decreased from 1.99% for the year ended March 31, 2009 to 1.07% for the year ended March 31, 2010. During fiscal year 2010, the Company primarily utilized the FRB for its borrowing needs, allowing it to take advantage of borrowings that averaged 0.28% for fiscal year 2010. The weighted average cost of FHLB and FRB borrowings, junior subordinated debenture and capital lease obligations decreased to 1.47% for the year ended March 31, 2010 from 2.59% for the prior year.

Provision for Loan Losses. The provision for loan losses for fiscal year 2010 was $15.9 million, compared to $16.2 million for the same period in the prior year. The provision for loan losses remained elevated as a result of the high level of classified loans, delinquencies, nonperforming loans and net charge-offs. The conditions were primarily the result of the weak economic conditions and slowdown in residential real estate sales that affected among others, homebuilders and developers.

Net charge-offs for the year ended March 31, 2010 were $11.2 million, compared to $9.9 million for the same period in prior year. The increase in net charge-offs was primarily attributable to the charge-off of land and lot loans totaling $3.8 million, speculative construction loans totaling $3.5 million and commercial loans totaling $2.5 million for the year ended March 31, 2010. Net charge-offs to average net loans for the year ended March 31, 2010 were 1.48%, compared to 1.24% for the same period in prior year. The ratio of allowance for loan losses to total net loans was 2.95% at March 31, 2010, compared to 2.12% at March 31, 2009.  The allowance as a percentage of nonperforming loans remained relatively unchanged at 60.1% at March 31, 2010, compared to 61.6% at March 31, 2009.

Impaired loans are subjected to an impairment analysis to determine an appropriate reserve amount to be held against each loan. As of March 31, 2010, the Company had identified $37.8 million of impaired loans. Because the significant majority of our impaired loans are collateral dependent, nearly all of our specific allowances are calculated based on the fair value of the collateral. Of those impaired loans, $7.7 million have no specific valuation allowance as their estimated collateral value is equal to or exceeds the carrying costs which in some cases is the result of previous loan charge-offs. The remaining $30.1 million have specific valuation allowances totaling $8.0 million. Based on its comprehensive analysis, management deemed the allowance for loan losses of $21.6 million at March 31, 2010 (2.95% of total loans and 60.1% of nonperforming loans) adequate to cover probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio.

Non-Interest Income.  Non-interest income increased $1.7 million to $7.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2010 from $5.5 million for the same period in 2009. The increase in non-interest income was primarily due to a $1.0 million OTTI charge on a trust preferred security taken during for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to a $3.4 million OTTI charge on the same security during the year ended March 31, 2009. Gain on sale of loans held for sale increased $158,000 for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to the same period in prior year. The increase was due to the increase in refinance activity the Company experienced in the first half of fiscal 2010 as homeowners took advantage of the historically low interest rates. These increases were partially offset by decreases in mortgage broker income and asset management fees. For the year ended March 31, 2010, broker loan fees decreased by $134,000 compared to the year ended March 31, 2009 primarily as a result the slowdown in real estate loan sales. Asset management fees decreased $192,000 for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to the same prior year period. The decrease in asset management fees was a result of the decrease in average assets under management of RAMCorp., which totaled $306.6 million at March 31, 2009 compared to $278.8
 
 
59

 
 
million at March 31, 2010. Total assets under management totaled $279.5 million at March 31, 2010 compared to $276.6 million at March 31, 2009.

Non-Interest Expense.  Non-interest expense increased $7.7 million to $35.0 million for fiscal year ended March 31, 2010 compared to $27.3 million for fiscal year ended March 31, 2009. The principal component of the increase in the Company’s non-interest expense was the increases in REO related expenses.  REO related expenses (which includes operating costs, write-downs, and losses on the disposition of property) increased $6.1 million for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to the same prior year period. In addition, the increase can also be attributable to an increase in professional fees of $207,000 for the year ended March 31, 2010 due primarily to legal fees related to problem assets, including REO. The Company’s FDIC deposit insurance premiums were $1.9 million for the year ended March 31, 2010, compared to $760,000 for the same prior year period. The increase in FDIC insurance premiums was a result of a FDIC special assessment during the first fiscal quarter of 2010 of $417,000 in addition to an industry wide increase in FDIC insurance premiums.

Income Taxes.  The benefit for income taxes was $3.3 million for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to $1.6 million for the year ended March 31, 2009.  The benefit for income taxes was a result of the pre-tax losses incurred for the years ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase from prior year was the result of the increase in pre-tax loss for the year ended March 31, 2010 compared to March 31, 2009. The effective tax rate for fiscal year 2010 was 37.6% compared to 37.1% for fiscal year 2009. Reference is made to Note 14 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K, for further discussion of the Company’s income taxes.

Average Balance Sheet.  The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, information regarding average balances of assets and liabilities as well as the total dollar amounts of interest income earned on average interest-earning assets and interest expense paid on average interest-bearing liabilities, resultant yields, interest rate spread, ratio of interest-earning assets to interest-bearing liabilities and net interest margin. Average balances for a period have been calculated using monthly average balances during such period. Interest income on tax-exempt securities has been adjusted to a taxable-equivalent basis using the statutory federal income tax rate of 34%. Non-accruing loans were included in the average loan amounts outstanding. Loan fees of $1.1 million, $1.2 million and $2.0 million are included in interest income for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 
60 

 

 
Year Ended March 31,
 
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
and
Dividends
 
Yield/
Cost
     
Average Balance
   
Interest
and
Dividends
 
Yield/
Cost
     
Average Balance
   
Interest
and
Dividends
 
Yield/
Cost
 
 
(Dollars in thousands)
Interest-earning assets:
                                                   
Mortgage loans
$
609,961
 
$
37,570
 
6.16
%
 
$
650,101
 
$
39,896
 
6.14
%
 
$
674,144
 
$
44,781
 
6.64
%
Non-mortgage loans
 
93,900
   
5,127
 
5.46
     
109,389
   
5,779
 
5.28
     
120,077
   
7,102
 
5.91
 
Total net loans
 
703,861
   
42,697
 
6.07
     
759,490
   
45,675
 
6.01
     
794,221
   
51,883
 
6.53
 
                                                     
Mortgage-backed securities (1)
 
2,428
   
88
 
3.62
     
3,738
   
136
 
3.64
     
5,348
   
211
 
3.95
 
Investment securities (1)
 
8,885
   
247
 
2.78
     
10,861
   
425
 
3.91
     
10,063
   
615
 
6.11
 
Daily interest-bearing assets
 
9,234
   
7
 
0.08
     
964
   
1
 
0.10
     
9,593
   
112
 
1.17
 
Other earning assets
 
34,439
   
203
 
0.59
     
21,113
   
79
 
0.37
     
8,515
   
100
 
1.17
 
   Total interest-earning assets
 
758,847
   
43,242
 
5.70
     
796,166
   
46,316
 
5.82
     
827,740
   
52,921
 
6.39
 
Non-interest-earning assets:
                                                   
Office properties and equipment, net
 
15,975
               
18,738
               
20,339
           
Other non-interest-earning assets
 
75,305
               
66,628
               
54,180
           
  Total assets
$
850,127
             
$
881,532
             
$
902,259
           
                                                     
Interest-bearing liabilities:
                                                   
Regular savings accounts
$
34,124
 
$
160
 
0.47
   
$
29,526
 
$
162
 
0.55
   
$
27,138
 
$
149
 
0.55
 
Interest checking
 
81,279
   
239
 
0.29
     
79,444
   
331
 
0.42
     
86,986
   
983
 
1.13
 
Money market accounts
 
214,490
   
1,846
 
0.86
     
192,064
   
2,360
 
1.23
     
173,853
   
3,810
 
2.19
 
Certificates of deposit
 
287,109
   
4,324
 
1.51
     
277,639
   
6,782
 
2.44
     
282,055
   
10,337
 
3.66
 
   Total interest-bearing deposits
 
617,002
   
6,569
 
1.06
     
578,673
   
9,635
 
1.67
     
570,032
   
15,279
 
2.68
 
                                                     
Other interest-bearing liabilities
 
32,340
   
1,483
 
4.59
     
118,408
   
1,741
 
1.47
     
150,681
   
3,904
 
2.59
 
   Total interest-bearing liabilities
 
649,342
   
8,052
 
1.24
     
697,081
   
11,376
 
1.63
     
720,713
   
19,183
 
2.66
 
                                                     
Non-interest-bearing liabilities:
                                                   
Non-interest-bearing deposits
 
91,167
               
87,508
               
81,566
           
Other liabilities
 
8,975
               
6,197
               
7,108
           
   Total liabilities
 
749,484
               
790,786
               
809,387
           
Shareholders’ equity
 
100,643
               
90,746
               
92,872
           
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
$
850,127
             
$
881,532
             
$
902,259
           
Net interest income
     
$
35,190
             
$
34,940
             
$
33,738
     
Interest rate spread
           
4.46
%
             
4.19
%
             
3.73
%
Net interest margin
           
4.64
%
             
4.39
%
             
4.08
%
                                                     
Ratio of average interest-earning assets
to average interest-bearing liabilities
           
116.86
%
             
114.21
%
             
114.85
%
                                                     
Tax Equivalent Adjustment (2)
     
$
28
             
$
54
             
$
71
     
 
 (1) For purposes of the computation of average yield on investments available for sale, historical cost balances were utilized, therefore, the yield information does not give effect to change in fair value that are reflected as a component of shareholders’ equity.
 (2) Tax-equivalent adjustment relates to non-taxable investment interest income and preferred equity securities dividend income.  The federal statutory tax rate was 34% for all years presented.


 
61 

 

Rate/Volume Analysis

The following table sets forth the effects of changing rates and volumes on net interest income of the Company. Information is provided with respect to: (i) effects on interest income attributable to changes in volume (changes in volume multiplied by prior rate); (ii) effects on interest income attributable to changes in rate (changes in rate multiplied by prior volume); and (iii) changes in rate/volume (change in rate multiplied by change in volume). Rate/volume variance is allocated based on the percentage relationship of changes in volume and changes in rate to the total net change.

 
Year Ended March 31,
 
2011 vs. 2010
 
2010 vs. 2009
                                       
 
Increase (Decrease) Due to
         
Increase (Decrease) Due to
       
             
Total
               
Total
 
             
Increase
               
Increase
 
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
(Decrease)
   
Volume
 
Rate
 
(Decrease)
 
 
(In thousands)
Interest Income:
                                     
Mortgage loans
$
(2,456
)
$
130
 
$
(2,326
)
 
$
(1,570
)
$
(3,315
)
$
(4,885
)
Non-mortgage loans
 
(843
)
 
191
   
(652
)
   
(602
)
 
(721
)
 
(1,323
)
Mortgage-backed securities
 
(47
)
 
(1
)
 
(48
)
   
(59
)
 
(16
)
 
(75
)
Investment securities (1)
 
(69
)
 
(109
)
 
(178
)
   
46
   
(236
)
 
(190
)
Daily interest-bearing
 
6
   
-
   
6
     
(55
)
 
(56
)
 
(111
)
Other earning assets
 
64
   
60
   
124
     
79
   
(100
)
 
(21
)
Total interest income
 
(3,345
)
 
271
   
(3,074
)
   
(2,161
)
 
(4,444
)
 
(6,605
)
                                       
Interest Expense:
                                     
Regular savings accounts
 
23
   
(25
)
 
(2
)
   
13
   
-
   
13
 
Interest checking accounts
 
8
   
(100
)
 
(92
)
   
(79
)
 
(573
)
 
(652
)
Money market deposit accounts
 
254
   
(768
)
 
(514
)
   
364
   
(1,814
)
 
(1,450
)
Certificates of deposit
 
222
   
(2,680
)
 
(2,458
)
   
(160
)
 
(3,395
)
 
(3,555
)
Other interest-bearing liabilities
 
(1,950
)
 
1,692
   
(258
)
   
(716
)
 
(1,447
)
 
(2,163
)
Total interest expense
 
(1,443
)
 
(1,881
)
 
(3,324
)
   
(578
)
 
(7,229
)
 
(7,807
)
Net interest income
$
(1,902
)
$
2,152
 
$
250
   
$
(1,583
)
$
2,785
 
$
1,202
 
                                       
 (1) Interest is presented on a fully tax-equivalent basis under a tax rate of 34%
                     

Asset and Liability Management

The Company's principal financial objective is to achieve long-term profitability while reducing its exposure to fluctuating market interest rates. The Company has sought to reduce the exposure of its earnings to changes in market interest rates by attempting to manage the difference between asset and liability maturities and interest rates. The principal element in achieving this objective is to increase the interest rate sensitivity of the Company's interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Interest rate sensitivity increases by retaining portfolio loans with interest rates subject to periodic adjustment to market conditions and selling fixed-rate one-to-four family mortgage loans with terms to maturity of more than 15 years. The Company relies on retail deposits as its primary source of funds. Management believes retail deposits reduce the effects of interest rate fluctuations because they generally represent a stable source of funds. As part of its interest rate risk management strategy, the Company promotes transaction accounts and certificates of deposit with terms up to ten years.

The Company has adopted a strategy that is designed to maintain or improve the interest rate sensitivity of assets relative to its liabilities. The primary elements of this strategy involve: the origination of adjustable rate loans; increasing commercial loans, consumer loans that are adjustable rate and other short-term loans as a portion of total net loans receivable because of their generally shorter terms and higher yields than other one-to-four family residential mortgage loans; matching asset and liability maturities; investing in short-term securities; and selling most long term, fixed rate, one-to-four family mortgage loan originations. The strategy for liabilities has been to shorten the maturities for both deposits and borrowings. The longer-term objective is to increase the proportion of noninterest bearing demand deposits, low interest bearing demand deposits, money market accounts, and savings deposits relative to certificates of deposit to reduce our overall cost of funds.

The Company's mortgage servicing activities provide additional protection from interest rate risk. The Company retains servicing rights on all mortgage loans sold. As market interest rates rise, the fixed rate loans held in portfolio diminish in value. However, the value of the servicing portfolio tends to rise as market interest rates increase because borrowers tend not
 
 
62

 
 
to prepay the underlying mortgages, thus providing an interest rate risk hedge versus the fixed rate loan portfolio. Loans serviced for others totaled $123.4 million of which $103.4 million is serviced for FHLMC at March 31, 2011. See "Item 1.  Business -- Lending Activities -- Mortgage Loan Servicing."

Consumer loans, such as home equity lines of credit and installment loans, commercial loans and construction loans typically have shorter terms and higher yields than permanent residential mortgage loans, and accordingly reduce the Company's exposure to fluctuations in interest rates. Adjustable interest rate loans totaled $468.8 million or 68.2% of total loans at March 31, 2011 as compared to $545.6 million or 74.3% at March 31, 2010. Although the Company has sought to originate adjustable rate loans, the ability to originate and purchase such loans depends to a great extent on market interest rates and borrowers' preferences. Particularly in lower interest rate environments, borrowers often prefer to obtain fixed rate loans. See Item 1. “Business - Lending Activities - Construction Lending" and “- Lending Activities - Consumer Lending."

The Company may also invest in short-term to medium-term U.S. Government securities as well as mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies.  At March 31, 2011, the combined portfolio carried at $8.8 million had an average term to repricing or maturity of 5.52 years.  Adjustable rate mortgage-backed securities totaled $489,000 at March 31, 2011 compared to $623,000 at March 31, 2010.  See Item 1. “Business -- Investment Activities."

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Liquidity is essential to our business.  The objective of the Bank’s liquidity management is to maintain ample cash flows to meet obligations for depositor withdrawals, to fund the borrowing needs of loan customers, and to fund ongoing operations.  Core relationship deposits are the primary source of the Bank’s liquidity.  As such, the Bank focuses on deposit relationships with local consumer and business clients who maintain multiple accounts and services at the Bank. With the significant downturn in economic conditions our customers in general have experienced reduced funds available to deposit in the Bank.  Despite these difficult economic conditions, customer relationship deposit balances remained constant at $652.5 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $652.3 million at March 31, 2010. Total deposits were $716.5 million at March 31, 2011 compared to $688.0 million at March 31, 2010. The growth in deposits; coupled with the decrease in the loan portfolio, provided the Company with the funds to payoff its secured borrowings from FHLB and FRB. The Company continues to focus on limiting its secured borrowings.

During fiscal 2011, the Company completed a secondary offering of its common stock. The Company sold 11.5 million shares resulting in net proceeds, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses, of $18.8 million. Riverview has allocated a significant portion of the net proceeds from the offering to strengthen the Bank’s regulatory capital ratios in accordance with the Bank’s MOU and to support managed growth as economic conditions improve. To that end, during the year ended March 31, 2011, the Company invested a cumulative $7.0 million as additional paid-in common equity in the Bank. The Company expects to use the remaining net proceeds for general working capital purposes, including additional capital investments in the Bank, if appropriate.

In response to the adverse economic conditions, the Company has been, and will continue to work toward reducing the amount of nonperforming assets, controlling balance sheet growth, reducing controllable operating costs, and augmenting deposits while striving to maximize secured borrowing facilities to improve liquidity and preserve capital over the coming fiscal year.  However, the Company’s inability to successfully implement its plans or further deterioration in economic conditions and real estate prices could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s liquidity.  During fiscal year 2010, the Company enrolled in an internet deposit listing service. Under this listing service, the Company may post time deposit rates on an internet site where institutional investors have the ability to deposit funds with the Company. The Company uses this listing service as an additional source of funding and to further diversify its funding sources. These deposits carry a lower interest rate than the Company core branch deposits. As of March 31, 2011, the Company had deposits totaling $31.6 million through this listing service.

Liquidity management is both a short- and long-term responsibility of the Company's management.  The Company adjusts its investments in liquid assets based upon management's assessment of (i) expected loan demand, (ii) projected loan sales, (iii) expected deposit flows, (iv) yields available on interest-bearing deposits and (v) its asset/liability management program objectives.  Excess liquidity is invested generally in interest-bearing overnight deposits and other short-term government and agency obligations.  If the Company requires funds beyond its ability to generate them internally, it has additional diversified and reliable sources of funds with the FHLB, the FRB, and other wholesale facilities. These sources of funds may be used on a long or short-term basis to compensate for reduction in other sources of funds or on a long-term basis to support lending activities. Beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2011, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on its outstanding $22.7 million aggregate principal amount of junior subordinated debentures issued in connection with the
 
 
63

 
 
sale of trust preferred securities through statutory business trusts.  The Company continued with the interest deferral at March 31, 2011.  As of March 31, 2011, the Company had deferred a total of $1.3 million of interest payments. The accrual for these payments is included in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets and interest expense on the Consolidated Statements of Operations. This deferral may adversely affect our ability to access wholesale funding facilities or obtain other debt financing on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. For more information concerning limitations on our ability to incur additional debt and the risks related to our recent deferral of interest on our trust preferred securities, see Item 1A. “Risk Factors – We are required to comply with the terms of two memoranda of understanding and a supervisory letter directive issued by the OTS and lack of compliance could result in monetary penalties and /or additional regulatory actions.” And “--We have deferred payments of interest on our outstanding junior subordinated debentures and as a result we are prohibited from declaring or paying dividends or distributions on, and from making liquidation payments with respect to, our common stock.”

The Company's primary source of funds is customer deposits, proceeds from principal and interest payments on loans, the sale of loans, maturing securities, FHLB advances and FRB borrowings. While maturities and scheduled amortization of loans and securities are a predictable source of funds, deposit flows and prepayment of mortgage loans and mortgage-backed securities are greatly influenced by general interest rates, economic conditions and competition. Management believes that its focus on core relationship deposits coupled with access to borrowing through reliable counterparties provides reasonable and prudent assurance that ample liquidity is available. However, depositor or counterparty behavior could change in response to competition, economic or market situations or other unforeseen circumstances, which could have liquidity implications that may require different strategic or operational actions.

The Company must maintain an adequate level of liquidity to ensure the availability of sufficient funds in order to fund loan originations and deposit withdrawals, satisfy other financial commitments and to take advantage of investment opportunities. We generally maintain cash and readily marketable securities to meet a portion of our short-term liquidity needs; however, our primary liquidity management practice is to increase or decrease short-term borrowings, including FHLB advances and FRB borrowings.  At March 31, 2011, there were no advances outstanding from FHLB. The Bank had additional borrowing capacity available of $204.0 million from the FHLB, subject to sufficient collateral and stock investment.  At March 31, 2011, there were no outstanding borrowings from the FRB. The Bank had additional borrowing capacity of $107.9 million from the FRB, subject to sufficient collateral. At March 31, 2011, the Bank had sufficient unpledged collateral to allow it to utilize its available borrowing capacity from the FRB and FHLB. Borrowing capacity from FHLB or FRB may fluctuate based on acceptability and risk rating of loan collateral and counterparties could adjust discount rates applied to such collateral at their discretion.

An additional source of wholesale funding includes brokered certificate of deposits.  The Company has historically not relied on brokered deposits to fund its operations. At March 31, 2011 and March 31, 2010 the Company had no brokered deposits, exclusive of CDARS and ICS deposits. The Bank participates in the CDARS and ICS products, which allow the Bank to accept deposits in excess of the FDIC insurance limits for that depositor and obtain “pass-through” insurance for the total deposit. The Bank’s CDARS and ICS balances were $36.6 million, or 5.1% of total deposits, and $31.9 million, or 4.6% of total deposits, at March 31, 2011 and March 31, 2010, respectively.  With news of bank failures and increased levels of distress in the financial services industry and customer concern with FDIC insurance limits, customer interest in and demand for CDARS deposits has remained strong with continued renewals of existing CDARS deposits and the opening of new accounts.

On June 9, 2009, the OTS informed the Bank that it was restricting the Bank’s brokered deposits to 10% of total deposits (including CDARS and ICS). Subsequently, as a result of the Bank’s improving financial condition, the OTS formally increased this limit to 20% of total deposits during March 2011. At June 9, 2009, the Company did not have any wholesale-brokered deposits, however, the Company had $20.4 million in CDARS deposits, which represented 3.2% of total deposits. The combination of all the Bank’s funding sources, gives the Bank available liquidity of $477.9 million, or 55.6% of total assets at March 31, 2011.

The Bank's deposits are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC. On July 21, 2010, the FDIC deposit insurance coverage was permanently raised to $250,000. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, beginning on January 1, 2011, all non-interest bearing transaction accounts and IOLTA accounts qualify for unlimited deposit insurance by the FDIC through December 31, 2012.  NOW accounts, which were previously fully insured under the Transaction Account Guarantee Program, are no longer be eligible for an unlimited guarantee due to the expiration of this program on December 31, 2010.  NOW accounts, along with all other deposits maintained at the Bank are now insured by the FDIC up to $250,000 per account owner. 
 
 
64

 

At March 31, 2011, the Company had commitments to extend credit of $8.1 million. The Company anticipates that it will have sufficient funds available to meet current loan commitments. Certificates of deposit that are scheduled to mature in less than one year from March 31, 2011 totaled $196.4 million.  Historically, the Company has been able to retain a significant amount of its deposits as they mature. Offsetting these cash outflows are scheduled loan maturities of less than one year totaling $159.8 million at March 31, 2011.

Sources of capital and liquidity for the Company include distributions from the Bank and the issuance of debt or equity securities. Dividends and other capital distributions from the Bank are subject to regulatory restrictions and approval. The Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on its Debentures for the year ended March 31, 2011, which in turn, restricts the Company’s ability to pay dividends on its common stock. The Company completed a secondary offering of its common stock during the second quarter of fiscal 2011. Net proceeds from this offering were $18.8 million.

OTS regulations require the Bank to maintain specific amounts of regulatory capital.  For a detailed discussion of regulatory capital requirements, see "Item 1. Business-“ Regulation -- Federal Regulation of Savings Associations -- Capital Requirements" and Note 17 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Effect of Inflation and Changing Prices

The Consolidated Financial Statements and related financial data presented herein have been prepared in accordance with GAAP, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars without considering the change in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation.  The primary impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost of the Company's operations. Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all the assets and liabilities of a financial institution are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates generally have a more significant impact on a financial institution's performance than do general levels of inflation.  Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction or to the same extent as the prices of goods and services.

New Accounting Pronouncements

For a discussion of new accounting pronouncement and their impact on the Company, see Note 1 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Contractual Obligations

The following table shows the contractual obligations by expected period. Further discussion of these commitments is included in Note 21 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

At March 31, 2011, scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit, FRB borrowings, FHLB advances, future operating minimum lease commitments, capital lease obligations and subordinated debentures were as follows (in thousands):

   
Within
1 Year
   
Over
1 to 3
Years
   
Over
3 - 5
Years
   
After
5 Years
   
Total
Balance
 
Certificates of deposit
  $ 196,388     $ 56,674     $ 6,218     $ 3,870     $ 263,150  
FRB borrowings
    -       -       -       -       -  
FHLB advances
    -       -       -       -       -  
Operating leases
    1,725       3,416       3,162       6,255       14,558  
Capital leases
    54       152       176       2,185       2,567  
Junior subordinates debentures
    -       -       -       22,681       22,681  
Total other contractual obligations
  $ 198,167     $ 60,242     $ 9,556     $ 34,991     $ 302,956  

The Company is party to litigation arising in the ordinary course of business.  In the opinion of management, these actions will not have a material adverse effect, if any, on the Company’s financial position, results of operations, or liquidity.

The Bank has entered into employment contracts with certain key employees, which provide for contingent payment subject to future events.


 
65 

 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments generally include commitments to originate mortgage, commercial and consumer loans. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the balance sheet. The Company’s maximum exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the borrower is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments as it does for on-balance sheet instruments. Commitments to originate loans are conditional, and are honored for up to 45 days subject to the Company’s usual terms and conditions. Collateral is not required to support commitments.

At March 31, 2011, the Company had commercial loan commitments of $378,000, undisbursed balances of commercial loans of $3.2 million and unused commercial lines of credit of $44.5 million. Commercial real estate mortgage loan commitments totaled $6.2 million and the undisbursed balance of commercial real estate mortgage loans was $2.6 million at March 31, 2011. At March 31, 2011, there were no construction loan commitments. Unused construction lines of credit totaled $15.8 million at March 31, 2011. Real estate one-to-four family loan commitments totaled $1.5 million and unused lines of credit secured by real estate one-to-four family loans totaled $18.5 million at March 31, 2011. Other installment loan commitments totaled $6,000 and unused lines of credit on other installment loans totaled $1.0 million at March 31, 2011. For additional information regarding future financial commitments, this discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with Note 21 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Quantitative Aspects of Market Risk.  The Company does not maintain a trading account for any class of financial instrument nor does it engage in hedging activities or purchase high-risk derivative instruments.  Furthermore, the Company is not subject to foreign currency exchange rate risk or commodity price risk.  For information regarding the sensitivity to interest rate risk of the Company's interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, see the tables under Item 1.  “Business -- Lending Activities,”  “-- Investment Activities” and “-- Deposit Activities and Other Sources of Funds” contained herein.

Qualitative Aspects of Market Risk.  The Company's principal financial objective is to achieve long-term profitability while limiting its exposure to fluctuating market interest rates.  The Company intends to reduce risk where appropriate but accepts a degree of risk when warranted by economic circumstances.  The Company has sought to reduce the exposure of its earnings to changes in market interest rates by attempting to manage the mismatch between asset and liability maturities and interest rates.  The principal element in achieving this objective is to increase the interest rate sensitivity of the Company's interest-earning assets by retaining in its portfolio, short–term loans and loans with interest rates subject to periodic adjustments.  The Company relies on retail deposits as its primary source of funds.  As part of its interest rate risk management strategy, the Company promotes transaction accounts and certificates of deposit with terms up to ten years.

Consumer and commercial loans are originated and held in portfolio as the short term nature of these portfolio loans match durations more closely with the short term nature of retail deposits such as interest checking, money market accounts and savings accounts. The Company relies on retail deposits as its primary source of funds. Management believes retail deposits reduce the effects of interest rate fluctuations because they generally represent a more stable source of funds. As part of its interest rate risk management strategy, the Company promotes transaction accounts and certificates of deposit with longer terms to maturity. Except for immediate short-term cash needs, and depending on the current interest rate environment, FHLB advances will have maturities of long or short term. FRB borrowings have short term maturities. For additional information, see Item 7. “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" contained herein.

A number of measures are utilized to monitor and manage interest rate risk, including simulation modeling and traditional interest rate gap analysis. While both methods provide an indication of risk for a given change in interest rates, the simulation model is primarily used to assess the impact on earning changes in interest rates may produce. Key assumptions in the model include cash flows and maturities of financial instruments, changes in market conditions, loan volumes and pricing, deposit sensitivity, consumer preferences and management’s capital leverage plans. These assumptions are inherently uncertain; therefore, the model cannot precisely estimate net interest income or precisely predict the impact of higher or lower interest rates on net interest income. Actual results may significantly differ from simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes and changes in market conditions and specific strategies among other factors.
 
 
66

 

The following tables show the approximate percentage change in net interest income as of March 31, 2011 over a 24-month period under several rate scenarios.
 
 
Change in interest rates
 
Percent change in net
interest income (12 months)
 
Percent change in net
interest income (24 months)
         
Up 300 basis points
 
(3.4)%
 
(0.3)%
Up 200 basis points
 
(3.9)%
 
(6.4)%
Base case
 
-
 
1.8%
Down 100 basis points
 
0.4%
 
2.5%

Our balance sheet continues to be slightly asset sensitive, meaning that interest-earning assets reprice faster than interest-bearing liabilities in a given period.  However, due to a number of loans in our loan portfolio with interest rate floors, our net interest income will be negatively impacted in a rising interest rate environment until such time as the current rate exceeds these interest rate floors.  Conversely, in a falling interest rate environment these interest rate floors will assist in maintaining our net interest income.  We attempt to limit our interest rate risk through managing the repricing characteristics of our assets and liabilities.

As with any method of measuring interest rate risk, certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of analysis presented in the foregoing table.  For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods of repricing, they may react in different degrees to changes in market interest rates.  Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities may fluctuate in advance of changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in market rates.  Additionally, certain assets, such as ARM loans, have features that restrict changes in interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the asset.  Furthermore, in the event of a change in interest rates, expected rates of prepayments on loans and early withdrawals from certificates could deviate significantly from those assumed in calculating the table.

The following table shows the Company's financial instruments that are sensitive to changes in interest rates, categorized by expected maturity, and the instruments' fair values at March 31, 2011.  Market risk sensitive instruments are generally defined as on- and off-balance sheet derivatives and other financial instruments.

 
Average
Rate
     
Within
1 Year
   
After
1 - 3
Years
   
After
3 - 5
Years
   
After
5 - 10
Years
   
Beyond
10
Years
   
Total
 
                                             
Interest-Sensitive Assets:
     
(Dollars in thousands)
 
                                           
Loans receivable
5.96
%
 
$
159,787
 
$
81,429
 
$
84,109
 
$
272,476
 
$
89,776
 
$
687,577
 
Mortgage-backed
                                         
securities
3.61
     
1,042
   
925
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
1,967
 
Investments and other
                                         
interest-earning assets
1.08
     
50,112
   
7,917
   
-
   
506
   
540
   
59,075
 
FHLB stock
-
     
1,470
   
2,940
   
2,940
   
-
   
-
   
7,350
 
Total assets
     
$
212,411
 
$
93,211
 
$
87,049
 
$
272,982
 
$
90,316
 
$
755,969
 
                                           
Interest-Sensitive Liabilities:
                                         
                                           
Interest checking
0.18
   
$
15,479
 
$
30,960
 
$
30,960
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
77,399
 
Savings accounts
0.35
     
7,447
   
14,892
   
14,892
   
-
   
-
   
37,231
 
Money market accounts
0.60
     
47,263
   
94,529
   
94,529
   
-
   
-
   
236,321
 
Certificate accounts
1.30
     
196,388
   
56,674
   
6,218
   
3,870
   
-
   
263,150
 
FHLB advances
-
     
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
 
FRB borrowings
-
     
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
 
Subordinated debentures
5.32
     
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
22,681
   
22,681
 
Obligations under capital lease
7.16
     
54
   
152
   
176
   
567
   
1,618
   
2,567
 
Total liabilities
       
266,631
   
197,207
   
146,775
   
4,437
   
24,299
   
639,349
 
Interest sensitivity gap
       
(54,220
)
 
(103,996
)
 
(59,726
)
 
268,545
   
66,017
 
$
116,620
 
Cumulative interest sensitivity gap
     
$
(54,220
)
$
(158,216
)
$
(217,942
)
$
50,603
 
$
116,620
       
Off-Balance Sheet Items:
                                         
                                           
Commitments to extend credit
-
   
$
8,107
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
8,107
 
Unused lines of credit
-
   
$
85,584
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
85,584
 

 
67 

 

Item 8.   Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
Consolidated Financial Statements for the Years Ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm


TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
   
 
Page
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm – Deloitte & Touche LLP
69
   
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of March 31, 2011 and 2010
70
   
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
71
   
Consolidated Statements of Equity for the Years Ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
72
   
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
73
   
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
74


 
68 

 

 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
 
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Riverview Bancorp, Inc.
Vancouver, Washington
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiary (the "Company") as of March 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2011.  These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiary as of March 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2011, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2011, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated June 8, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

 
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP
 
Portland, Oregon
June 8, 2011
 

 
69 

 


 
RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
MARCH 31, 2011 AND 2010

 (In thousands, except share and per share data)
 
 
2011
   
 
2010
 
ASSETS
           
Cash and cash equivalents (including interest-earning accounts of $37,349 and $3,384)
$
51,752
 
$
13,587
 
Certificates of deposit held for investment
 
14,900
   
-
 
Loans held for sale
 
173
   
255
 
Investment securities held to maturity, at amortized cost
(fair value of $556 and $573)
 
506
   
517
 
Investment securities available for sale, at fair value
(amortized cost of $8,514 and $8,706)
 
6,320
   
6,802
 
Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity, at amortized
cost (fair value of $199 and $265)
 
190
   
259
 
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale, at fair value
(amortized cost of $1,729 and $2,746)
 
1,777
   
2,828
 
Loans receivable (net of allowance for loan losses of $14,968 and $21,642)
 
672,609
   
712,837
 
Real estate owned
 
27,590
   
13,325
 
Prepaid expenses and other assets
 
5,887
   
7,934
 
Accrued interest receivable
 
2,523
   
2,849
 
Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost
 
7,350
   
7,350
 
Premises and equipment, net
 
16,100
   
16,487
 
Deferred income taxes, net
 
9,447
   
11,177
 
Mortgage servicing rights, net
 
396
   
509
 
Goodwill
 
25,572
   
25,572
 
Core deposit intangible, net
 
219
   
314
 
Bank owned life insurance
 
15,952
   
15,351
 
TOTAL ASSETS
$
859,263
 
$
837,953
 
             
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
           
             
LIABILITIES:
           
Deposit accounts
$
716,530
 
$
688,048
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
 
9,396
   
6,833
 
Advanced payments by borrowers for taxes and insurance
 
680
   
427
 
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
 
-
   
23,000
 
Federal Reserve Bank borrowings
 
-
   
10,000
 
Junior subordinated debentures
 
22,681
   
22,681
 
Capital lease obligations
 
2,567
   
2,610
 
Total liabilities
 
751,854
   
753,599
 
             
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (See Note 21)
           
             
EQUITY:
           
Shareholders’ equity
           
Serial preferred stock, $.01 par value; 250,000 authorized, issued and outstanding: none
 
-
   
-
 
Common stock, $.01 par value; 50,000,000 authorized
           
March 31, 2011 – 22,471,890 issued and outstanding
 
225
   
109
 
March 31, 2010 – 10,923,773 issued and outstanding
           
Additional paid-in capital
 
65,639
   
46,948
 
Retained earnings
 
43,193
   
38,878
 
Unearned shares issued to employee stock ownership trust
 
(696
)
 
(799
)
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
(1,417
)
 
(1,202
)
Total shareholders’ equity
 
106,944
   
83,934
 
             
Noncontrolling interest
 
465
   
420
 
Total equity
 
107,409
   
84,354
 
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
$
859,263
 
$
837,953
 
  See notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
70 

 

RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 AND 2009

(Dollars in thousands, except share data)
 
2011
     
2010
     
2009
 
                       
INTEREST AND DIVIDEND INCOME:
                     
Interest and fees on loans receivable
$
42,697
   
$
45,675
   
$
51,883
 
Interest on investment securities – taxable
 
164
     
267
     
407
 
Interest on investment securities – non taxable
 
55
     
104
     
137
 
Interest on mortgage-backed securities
 
88
     
136
     
211
 
Other interest and dividends
 
210
     
80
     
212
 
Total interest and dividend income
 
43,214
     
46,262
     
52,850
 
                       
INTEREST EXPENSE:
                     
Interest on deposits
 
6,569
     
9,635
     
15,279
 
Interest on borrowings
 
1,483
     
1,741
     
3,904
 
Total interest expense
 
8,052
     
11,376
     
19,183
 
Net interest income
 
35,162
     
34,886
     
33,667
 
Less provision for loan losses
 
5,075
     
15,900
     
16,150
 
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
 
30,087
     
18,986
     
17,517
 
                       
NON-INTEREST INCOME:
                     
Fees and service charges
 
4,047
     
4,513
     
4,669
 
Asset management fees
 
2,079
     
1,885
     
2,077
 
Net gain on sale of loans held for sale
 
393
     
887
     
729
 
Impairment on investment security
 
-
     
(1,003
)
   
(3,414
)
Bank owned life insurance
 
601
     
603
     
573
 
Other
 
769
     
381
     
896
 
Total non-interest income
 
7,889
     
7,266
     
5,530
 
                       
NON-INTEREST EXPENSE:
                     
Salaries and employee benefits
 
16,716
     
15,326
     
15,080
 
Occupancy and depreciation
 
4,677
     
4,814
     
5,064
 
Data processing
 
1,067
     
957
     
841
 
Amortization of core deposit intangible
 
96
     
111
     
131
 
Advertising and marketing expense
 
749
     
627
     
727
 
FDIC insurance premium
 
1,640
     
1,912
     
760
 
State and local taxes
 
638
     
732
     
668
 
Telecommunications
 
428
     
440
     
466
 
Professional fees
 
1,310
     
1,317
     
1,110
 
Real estate owned expenses
 
1,817
     
6,421
     
317
 
Other
 
2,358
     
2,316
     
2,095
 
Total non-interest expense
 
31,496
     
34,973
     
27,259
 
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES
 
6,480
     
(8,721
)
   
(4,212
)
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES
 
2,165
     
(3,277
)
   
(1,562
)
NET INCOME (LOSS)
$
4,315
   
$
(5,444
)
 
$
(2,650
)
                       
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                     
Basic
$
0.24
   
$
(0.51
)
 
$
(0.25
)
Diluted
 
0.24
     
(0.51
)
   
(0.25
)
Weighted average number of shares outstanding:
                     
Basic
 
18,341,191
     
10,720,525
     
10,693,795
 
Diluted
 
18,341,308
     
10,720,525
     
10,693,795
 
See notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
71 

 

RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EQUITY
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 AND 2009
(In thousands, except share data)
Common Stock
   
Additional Paid-In
Capital
   
Retained
Earnings
   
Unearned
Shares
Issued to
Employee
Stock
Ownership
Trust
   
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
   
Noncontrolling Interest
   
Total
 
Shares
   
Amount
                           
                                                 
Balance April 1, 2008
10,913,773
 
$
109
 
$
46,799
 
$
46,871
 
$
(976
)
$
(218
)
$
292
 
$
92,877
   
                                                 
Cash dividends ($0.135 per share)
-
   
-
   
-
   
(1,441
)
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
(1,441
)
 
Exercise of stock options
10,000
   
-
   
96
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
96
   
Earned ESOP shares
-
   
-
   
(31
)
 
-
   
74
   
-
   
-
   
43
   
Cumulative effect of adopting
    ASC 320
-
   
-
   
-
   
1,542
   
-
   
(1,542
)
 
-
   
-
   
Tax benefit, stock options
                 -
   
-
   
2
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
2
   
                                                 
Comprehensive loss:
                                               
Net loss
-
   
-
   
-
   
(2,650
)
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
(2,650
)
 
Other comprehensive income:
                                               
Unrealized holding gain on
                                               
securities of $2,225  (net of $1,146 tax effect) less reclassification adjustment for net losses included in net loss of $2,253 (net of $1,161 tax effect)
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
28
   
-
   
28
   
Noncontrolling interest
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
72
   
72
   
                                                 
Total comprehensive loss
                 -
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
              -
   
-
   
(2,550
)
 
Balance March 31, 2009
10,923,773
   
109
   
46,866
   
44,322
   
(902
)
 
(1,732
)
 
364
   
89,027
   
                                                 
Stock option expense
-
   
-
   
112
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
112
   
Earned ESOP shares
-
   
-
   
(30
)
       
103
   
-
   
-
   
73
   
                                                 
Comprehensive loss:
                                               
Net loss
-
   
-
   
-
   
(5,444
)
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
(5,444
)
 
Other comprehensive income:
                                               
Unrealized holding gain on securities of $132 (net of $14 tax effect) less reclassification adjustment for net losses included in net loss of $662 (net of $341 tax effect)
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
530
   
-
   
530
   
Noncontrolling interest
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
56
   
56
   
                                                 
Total comprehensive loss
                 -
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
(4,858
)
 
Balance March 31, 2010
10,923,773
   
109
   
46,948
   
38,878
   
(799
)
 
(1,202
)
 
420
   
84,354
   
                                                 
Issuance of common stock, net
11,548,117
   
116
   
18,653
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
18,769
   
Stock option expense
-
   
-
   
77
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
77
   
Earned ESOP shares
-
   
-
   
(39
)
 
-
   
103
   
-
   
-
   
64
   
                                                 
Comprehensive income:
                                               
Net income
-
   
-
   
-
   
4,315
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
4,315
   
Other comprehensive income (loss):
                                               
Unrealized holding loss on securities of $215 (net of $109 tax effect)
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
(215
)
 
-
   
(215
)
 
Noncontrolling interest
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
45
   
45
   
Total comprehensive income
                                         
4,145
   
                                                 
Balance March 31, 2011
22,471,890
 
$
225
 
$
65,639
 
$
43,193
 
$
(696
)
$
(1,417
)
$
465
 
$
107,409
   
                                                 
See notes to consolidated financial statements.


 
72 

 
 
RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 AND 2009
(In thousands)
 
2011
     
2010
     
2009
 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
                     
Net income (loss)
$
4,315
   
$
(5,444
)
 
$
(2,650
)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to cash provided by operating activities:
                     
Depreciation and amortization
 
1,927
     
2,225
     
2,320
 
Mortgage servicing rights valuation adjustment
 
(1
)
   
2
     
(6
)
Provision for loan losses
 
5,075
     
15,900
     
16,150
 
Provision (benefit) for deferred income taxes
 
1,841
     
(3,295
)
   
(3,653
)
Noncash expense related to ESOP
 
64
     
73
     
43
 
Increase (decrease) in deferred loan origination fees, net of amortization
 
57
     
(31
)
   
179
 
Origination of loans held for sale
 
(12,166
)
   
(29,514
)
   
(27,997
)
Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale
 
12,402
     
30,851
     
26,782
 
Stock based compensation
 
77
     
112
     
-
 
Excess tax benefit from stock based compensation
 
-
     
-
     
(11
)
Writedown of real estate owned
 
924
     
4,794
     
100
 
Loss on impairment of security
 
-
     
1,003
     
3,414
 
Net gain on loans held for sale, sale of real estate owned, mortgage-backed
securities, sale of investment securities and premises and equipment
 
(775
)
   
(6
)
   
(618
)
Income from bank owned life insurance
 
(601
)
   
(603
)
   
(573
)
Changes in assets and liabilities:
                     
Prepaid expenses and other assets
 
1,904
     
(5,567
)
   
93
 
Accrued interest receivable
 
326
     
205
     
382
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
 
2,763
     
(831
)
   
(573
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
18,132
     
9,874
     
13,382
 
                       
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
                     
Loan repayments (originations), net
 
15,213
     
41,729
     
(57,891
)
Proceeds from call, maturity, or sale of investment securities available for sale
 
9,990
     
6,150
     
480
 
Principal repayments on investment securities available for sale
 
203
     
375
     
75
 
Purchase of investment securities held to maturity
 
-
     
-
     
(536
)
Purchase of investment securities available for sale
 
(10,000
)
   
(4,988
)
   
(5,000
)
Principal repayments on mortgage-backed securities available for sale
 
1,017
     
1,244
     
1,341
 
Principal repayments on mortgage-backed securities held to maturity
 
69
     
311
     
315
 
Principal repayments on investment securities held to maturity
 
11
     
12
     
7
 
Purchase of premises and equipment and capitalized software
 
(1,310
)
   
(475
)
   
(545
)
Purchase of certificates of deposit held for investment, net
 
(14,900
)
   
-
     
-
 
Capital expenditures on real estate owned
 
(49
)
   
(47
)
   
-
 
Proceeds from sale of real estate owned and premises and equipment
 
5,328
     
12,044
     
431
 
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
5,572
     
56,355
     
(61,323
)
                       
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                     
Net change in deposit accounts
 
28,482
     
17,982
     
3,066
 
Dividends paid
 
-
     
-
     
(2,402
)
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net
 
18,769
     
-
     
-
 
Proceeds from borrowings
 
124,450
     
922,600
     
1,321,510
 
Repayment of borrowings
 
(157,450
)
   
(1,012,450
)
   
(1,291,510
)
Principal payments under capital lease obligation
 
(43
)
   
(40
)
   
(37
)
Net increase (decrease) in advance payments by borrowers
 
253
     
67
     
(33
)
Excess tax benefit from stock based compensation
 
-
     
-
     
11
 
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
 
-
     
-
     
96
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
14,461
     
(71,841
)
   
30,701
 
                       
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
 
38,165
     
(5,612
)
   
(17,240
)
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR
 
13,587
     
19,199
     
36,439
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR
$
51,752
   
$
13,587
   
$
19,199
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:
                     
Cash paid during the year for:
                     
Interest
$
6,688
   
$
11,343
   
$
19,372
 
Income taxes
 
387
     
1,320
     
1,538
 
NONCASH INVESTING AND FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                     
Transfer of loans to real estate owned, net
$
20,048
   
$
16,085
   
$
14,306
 
Fair value adjustment to securities available for sale
 
(324
)
   
857
     
43
 
Income tax effect related to fair value adjustment
 
109
     
(327
)
   
(15
)
Capitalized software acquired under a service agreement
 
-
     
19
     
130
 
Sale-leaseback of building
 
-
     
2,000
     
-
 

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

 
73 

 

RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 
1.    
SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Principles of Consolidation – The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company”); its wholly-owned subsidiary, Riverview Community Bank (the “Bank”); the Bank’s wholly-owned subsidiary, Riverview Services, Inc.; and the Bank’s majority owned subsidiary, Riverview Asset Management Corp. (“RAMCorp”). All inter-company transactions and balances have been eliminated in consolidation.

The Company has also established two subsidiary grantor trusts in connection with the issuance of trust preferred securities (see Note 13). In accordance with accounting standards, the accounts and transactions of the trusts are not included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

Nature of Operations – The Bank is a seventeen branch community-oriented financial institution operating in rural and suburban communities in southwest Washington State and Multnomah, Clackamas and Marion counties of Oregon. The Bank is engaged primarily in the business of attracting deposits from the general public and using such funds, together with other borrowings, to invest in various commercial business, commercial real estate, multi-family real estate, real estate construction, residential real estate and consumer loans.

Use of Estimates in the Preparation of Financial Statements – The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“generally accepted accounting principles” or “GAAP”), requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of certain assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of related revenue and expense during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Cash and Cash Equivalents – Cash and cash equivalents include amounts on hand, due from banks and interest-earning deposits in other banks. Cash and cash equivalents have a maturity of 90 days or less at the time of purchase.

Certificates of Deposit Held for Investment – Certificates of deposit held for investments include amounts invested with financial institutions for a stated interest rate and maturity date. Early withdraw penalties apply, however the Company plans to hold these investments to maturity.

Loans Held for Sale – The Company identifies loans held for sale at the time of origination and such loans are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or net realizable value. Market values are derived from available market quotations for comparable pools of mortgage loans. Adjustments for unrealized losses, if any, are charged to income.

Gains or losses on sales of loans held for sale are recognized at the time of sale and are determined by the difference between the net sales proceeds and the allocated basis of these loans sold. The Company capitalizes mortgage servicing rights (“MSRs”) acquired through either the purchase of MSRs, the sale of originated mortgage loans or the securitization of mortgage loans with servicing rights retained. Upon sale of mortgage loans held for sale, the total cost of the loans designated for sale is allocated to mortgage loans with and without MSRs based on their relative fair values. The MSRs are included as a component of gain on sale of loans. The MSRs are amortized in proportion to and over the estimated period of the net servicing income, such amortization is reflected as a component of loan servicing income.

Securities – Investment securities are classified as held to maturity when the Company has the ability and positive intent to hold such securities to maturity. Investment securities held to maturity are carried at amortized cost. Unrealized losses due to fluctuations in fair value are recognized when it is determined that a credit related other than temporary decline in value has occurred. Investment securities bought and held principally for the purpose of sale in the near term are classified as trading securities. Securities that the Company intends to hold for an indefinite period, but not necessarily to maturity are classified as available for sale. Such securities may be sold to implement the Company’s asset/liability management strategies and in response to changes in interest rates and similar factors.  Securities available for sale are reported at fair value. Unrealized gains and losses, net of the related deferred tax effect, are reported as a net amount in a separate component of shareholders’ equity entitled “accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).” Realized gains and losses on securities available for sale, determined using the specific identification method, are included in earnings.  Amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts are recognized in interest income over the period to maturity or expected call, if sooner.
 
 
 
74

 

The Company analyzes investment securities for other than temporary impairment (“OTTI”) on a quarterly basis.  OTTI is separated into a credit and noncredit component.  Noncredit component losses are recorded in other comprehensive income (loss) when the Company a) does not intend to sell the security or b) is not more likely than not to have to sell the security prior to the security’s anticipated recovery.  Credit component losses are reported in non-interest income.

Loans – Loans are stated at the amount of unpaid principal, reduced by deferred loan origination fees and an allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans is accrued daily based on the principal amount outstanding.

Loans are reviewed regularly and it is the Company’s general policy that a loan is past due when it is 30 days to 89 days delinquent. In general, when a loan is 90 days delinquent or when collection of principal or interest appears doubtful, it is placed on non-accrual status, at which time the accrual of interest ceases and a reserve for unrecoverable accrued interest is established and charged against operations. Payments received on non-accrual loans are applied to reduce the outstanding principal balance on a cash-basis method. As a general practice, a loan is not removed from non-accrual status until all delinquent principal, interest and late fees have been brought current and the borrower has demonstrated a history of performance based upon the contractual terms of the note.

Loan origination and commitment fees and certain direct loan origination costs are deferred and amortized as an adjustment of the yield of the related loan.

Allowance for Loan Losses – The allowance for loan losses is maintained at a level sufficient to provide for probable loan losses based on evaluating known and inherent risks in the loan portfolio. The allowance is provided based upon management’s ongoing quarterly assessment of the pertinent factors underlying the quality of the loan portfolio. These factors include changes in the size and composition of the loan portfolio, delinquency levels, actual loan loss experience, current economic conditions, and detailed analysis of individual loans for which full collectibility may not be assured.  The detailed analysis includes techniques to estimate the fair value of loan collateral and the existence of potential alternative sources of repayment. The allowance consists of specific, general and unallocated components. The specific component relates to loans that are considered impaired. For such loans that are classified as impaired, an allowance is established when the net realizable value of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan. The general component covers non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses. Such factors include uncertainties in economic conditions, uncertainties in identifying triggering events that directly correlate to subsequent loss rates, changes in appraised value of underlying collateral, risk factors that have not yet manifested themselves in loss allocation factors and historical loss experience data that may not precisely correspond to the current portfolio or economic conditions.  The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio. The appropriate allowance level is estimated based upon factors and trends identified by management at the time the consolidated financial statements are prepared.

When available information confirms that specific loans or portions thereof are uncollectible, identified amounts are charged against the allowance for loan losses. The existence of some or all of the following criteria will generally confirm that a loss has been incurred: the loan is significantly delinquent and the borrower has not demonstrated the ability or intent to bring the loan current; the Bank has no recourse to the borrower, or if it does, the borrower has insufficient assets to pay the debt; the estimated fair value of the loan collateral is significantly below the current loan balance, and there is little or no near-term prospect for improvement.

A loan is considered impaired when it is probable that a creditor will be unable to collect all amounts (principal and interest) due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Typically, factors used in determining if a loan is impaired are, but not limited to, loans 90 days or more delinquent, loans internally designated as substandard, loans that are on non-accrual status or trouble debt restructures. The majority of the Company’s impaired loans are considered collateral dependent. When a loan is considered collateral dependent impairment is measured using the estimated value of the underlying collateral, less any prior liens, and estimated selling costs. For impaired loans that are not collateral dependent impairment is measured using the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. When the net realizable value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan (including accrued interest, net deferred loan fees or costs, and unamortized premium or discount), an impairment is recognized by adjusting an allocation of the allowance for loan losses. Subsequent to the initial allocation of allowance to the individual loan the Company may conclude that it is appropriate to record a charge-off of the impaired portion of the loan. When a charge-off is recorded the loan balance is reduced and the specific allowance is eliminated. Generally, when a collateral dependent loan is initially measured for impairment and does not have an appraisal performed in the last three months, the Company obtains an updated market valuation. Subsequently, the
 
 
75

 
 
Company obtains an updated market valuation on an annual basis. The valuation may occur more frequently if the Company determines that there is an indication that the market value may have declined.

In accordance with the Company’s policy guidelines, unsecured loans are generally charged-off when no payments have been received for three consecutive months unless an alternative action plan is in effect. Consumer installment loans delinquent six months or more that have not received at least 75% of their required monthly payment in the last 90 days are charged-off. In addition, loans discharged in bankruptcy proceedings are charged-off. Loans under bankruptcy protection with no payments received for four consecutive months will be charged-off. The outstanding balance of a secured loan that is in excess of the net realizable value is generally charged-off if no payments are received for four to five consecutive months. However, charge-offs are postponed if alternative proposals to restructure, obtain additional guarantors, obtain additional assets as collateral or a potential sale would result in full repayment of the outstanding loan balance. Once any of these or other repayment potentials are considered exhausted the impaired portion of the loan is charged-off, unless an updated valuation of the collateral reveals no impairment.

A provision for loan losses is charged against income and is added to the allowance for loan losses based on regular assessments of the loan portfolio. The allowance for loan losses is allocated to certain loan categories based on the relative risk characteristics, asset classifications and actual loss experience of the loan portfolio. While management has allocated the allowance for loan losses to various loan portfolio segments, the allowance is general in nature and is available for the loan portfolio in its entirety.

The ultimate recovery of all loans is susceptible to future market factors beyond the Company’s control. There can be no assurance that the Company will not be required to make future adjustments to the allowance in response to changing economic conditions, particularly in the Company’s primary market, since the majority of the Company’s loans are collateralized by real estate. In addition, regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses, and may require the Company to make additions to the allowance based on their judgment about information available to them at the time of their examinations.

Allowance for Unfunded Loan Commitments – The allowance for unfunded loan commitments is maintained at a level believed by management to be sufficient to absorb estimated probable losses related to these unfunded credit facilities. The determination of the adequacy of the allowance is based on periodic evaluations of the unfunded credit facilities including an assessment of the probability of commitment usage, credit risk factors for loans outstanding to these same customers, and the terms and expiration dates of the unfunded credit facilities. The allowance for unfunded loan commitments is included in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets, with changes to the balance charged against non-interest expense.

Real Estate Owned (“REO”) – REO consists of properties acquired through foreclosure, which includes REO held for sale and REO held for investment. Specific charge-offs are taken based upon detailed analysis of the fair value of collateral on the underlying loans on which the Company is in the process of foreclosing. Such collateral is transferred into REO at the lower of recorded cost or fair value less estimated costs of disposal. Subsequently, the Company performs an evaluation of the properties and writes down the REO directly and charges real estate owned expenses for any declines in value. The amounts the Company will ultimately recover from REO may differ from the amounts used in arriving at the net carrying value of these assets because of future market factors beyond the Company’s control or because of changes in the Company’s strategy for the sale of the property.

Federal Home Bank Loan Bank Stock – The Bank, as a member of Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle (“FHLB”), is required to maintain an investment in capital stock of the FHLB in an amount equal to the greater of 1% of its outstanding home loans or 5% of advances from the FHLB. The Company views its investment in FHLB stock as a long-term investment. Accordingly, when evaluating for impairment, the value is determined based on the ultimate redemption of the par value rather than recognizing temporary declines in value. The determination of whether a decline affects the ultimate redemption is influenced by criteria such as: 1) the significance of the decline in net assets of the FHLB as compared to the capital stock amount and length of time a decline has persisted; 2) impact of legislative and regulatory changes on the FHLB and 3) the liquidity position of the FHLB. The FHLB had a deterioration in its financial position and as a result had a risk-based capital deficiency under the regulations of its primary federal regulator. Therefore, the Company evaluated its investment in FHLB stock for other than temporary impairment, consistent with its accounting policy. Based on the Company’s evaluation of the underlying investment, including the long-term nature of the investment, the liquidity position of the FHLB, the actions being taken by the FHLB to address its regulatory situation and the Company’s intent and ability to hold the investment for a period of time sufficient to be able to redeem its investment at par value, the Company did not recognize an other than temporary impairment loss on its FHLB stock. However, this estimate could change in the near term if: 1) significant other-than-temporary losses are incurred on the
 
 
76

 
 
mortgage backed securities causing a significant decline in their regulatory capital status; 2) the economic losses resulting from credit deterioration on the mortgage backed securities increases significantly and 3) capital preservation strategies being utilized by the FHLB become ineffective.

Premises and Equipment – Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the term of the lease or the estimated useful life of the improvements, whichever is less. Gains or losses on dispositions are reflected in earnings. Depreciation is generally computed on the straight-line method over the following estimated useful lives: building and improvements – up to 45 years; furniture and equipment – three to twenty years; and leasehold improvements – fifteen to twenty-five years. The cost of maintenance and repairs is charged to expense as incurred.  Assets are reviewed for impairment when events indicate their carrying value may not be recoverable.  If management determines impairment exists the asset is reduced by an offsetting charge to expense.

The capitalized lease, less accumulated amortization is included in premises and equipment. The capitalized lease is amortized on a straight-line basis over the lease term and the amortization is included in depreciation expense.

Mortgage Servicing Rights – Fees earned for servicing loans for the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“FHLMC”) are reported as income when the related mortgage loan payments are collected. Loan servicing costs are charged to expense as incurred.

MSRs are the rights to service loans. Loan servicing includes collecting payments, remitting funds to investors, insurance companies and tax authorities, collecting delinquent payments, and foreclosing on properties when necessary.

The Company records its originated MSRs at fair value in accordance with accounting standards, which requires the Company to allocate the total cost of all mortgage loans sold to the MSRs and the loans (without the MSRs) based on their relative fair values if it is practicable to estimate those fair values. The Company stratifies its MSRs based on the predominant characteristics of the underlying financial assets including coupon interest rate and contractual maturity of the mortgage. An estimated fair value of MSRs is determined quarterly using a discounted cash flow model.  The model estimates the present value of the future net cash flows of the servicing portfolio based on various factors, such as servicing costs, servicing income, expected prepayment speeds, discount rate, loan maturity and interest rate. The effect of changes in market interest rates on estimated rates of loan prepayments represents the predominant risk characteristic underlying the MSRs portfolio. The Company is amortizing the MSRs in proportion to and over the period of estimated net servicing income.

MSRs are reviewed quarterly for impairment based on their fair value. The fair value of the MSRs, for the purposes of impairment, is measured using a discounted cash flow analysis based on market adjusted discount rates, anticipated prepayment speeds, mortgage loan term and coupon rate.  Market sources are used to determine prepayment speeds, ancillary income, servicing cost and pre-tax required yield.  Impairment losses are recognized through a valuation allowance for each impaired stratum, with any associated provision recorded as a component of loan servicing income.

Goodwill – Goodwill is initially recorded when the purchase price paid for an acquisition exceeds the estimated fair value of the net identified tangible and intangible assets acquired.  Goodwill is presumed to have an indefinite useful life and is tested, at least annually, for impairment at the reporting unit level.  The Company performs an annual review in the third quarter of each year, or more frequently if indicators of potential impairment exist, to determine if the recorded goodwill is impaired.  The impairment test is performed in two phases.  The first step of the goodwill impairment test compares the fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill.  If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill is considered not impaired; however, if the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds its fair value, a second phase step must be performed.  In the second step the implied fair value of the reporting unit is calculated. The implied fair value of goodwill is then compared to the carrying amount of goodwill on the Company’s balance sheet.  If the carrying amount of the goodwill is greater than the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss must be recognized in an amount equal to that excess.  As of March 31, 2011, the Company has not recognized any impairment loss on the recorded goodwill.

Core Deposit Intangible – Core deposit intangibles are amortized to non-interest expense using an accelerated method (based on expected attrition and cash flows of core deposit accounts purchased) over ten years.

Advertising and Marketing Expense – Costs incurred for advertising, merchandising, market research, community investment and business development are classified as marketing expense and are expensed as incurred.

 
 
77

 
Income Taxes – Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Under this method, a deferred tax asset or liability is determined based on the enacted tax rates which will be in effect when the differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and tax basis of existing assets and liabilities are expected to be reported in the Company’s income tax returns. The effect on deferred taxes of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. Valuation allowances are established to reduce the net carrying amount of deferred tax assets if it is determined to be more likely than not, that all or some portion of the potential deferred tax asset will not be realized. The Company files a consolidated federal income tax return. The Bank provides for income taxes separately and remits to the Company amounts currently due.

Trust Assets – Assets held by RAMCorp. in a fiduciary or agency capacity for trust customers are not included in the consolidated financial statements because such items are not assets of the Company. Assets totaling $328.1 million and $279.5 million were held in trust as of March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Earnings Per Share – The Company accounts for earnings per share in accordance with applicable accounting standards, which requires all companies whose capital structure includes dilutive potential common shares to make a dual presentation of basic and diluted earnings per share for all periods presented. Basic earnings per share is computed by dividing income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period, excluding restricted stock and unallocated shares owned by the Company’s Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”).  Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock were exercised and has been computed after giving consideration to the weighted average diluted effect of the Company’s stock options.

Stock-Based Compensation – The Company accounts for stock based compensation in accordance with accounting guidance for stock compensation. The guidance requires measurement of the compensation cost for all stock-based awards based on the grant-date fair value and recognition of compensation cost over the service period of stock-based awards. The fair value of stock options is determined using the Black-Scholes valuation model.

Employee Stock Ownership Plan – The Company sponsors a leveraged ESOP. As shares are released, compensation expense is recorded equal to the then current market price of the shares and the shares become available for earnings per share calculations. The Company records cash dividends on unallocated shares as a reduction of debt and accrued interest.

Business segments – The Company operates a single business segment. The financial information that is used by the chief operating decision maker in allocating resources and assessing performance is only provided for one reportable segment for years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.
 
Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements - In January 2010, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued FASB Accounting Standards Update (ASU) No. 2010-06 on fair value measurements and disclosures, which focuses on improving disclosures about fair value measurement.  The standards update requires new disclosures about transfers in and out of Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements and the activity in Level 3 fair value measurements (i.e. purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements).  This accounting standards update also amended disclosure requirements related to the level of disaggregation of assets and liabilities, as well as disclosures about input and valuation techniques used to measure fair value for both recurring and nonrecurring fair value measurements.  The new guidance became effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the disclosures about purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements in the roll forward of activity in Level 3 fair value measurements which are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. The adoption of this accounting standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
 
In July 2010, the FASB issued FASB ASU No. 2010-20 that improves the disclosures that an entity provides about the credit quality of its financing receivables and the related allowance for loan losses. As a result of these amendments, an entity is required to disaggregate by portfolio segment or class certain existing disclosures and provide certain new disclosures about its financing receivables and related allowance for credit losses. The guidance is effective for interim and annual reporting periods ending on or after December 15, 2010. The adoption of this accounting standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial position or results of operations.

New Accounting Pronouncements In December 2010, the FASB issued FASB ASU No. 2010-28 regarding intangibles such as goodwill and when to perform Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test for reporting units with zero or negative carrying amounts.  The amendments in this update modify Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test for reporting
 
 
78

 
 
units with zero or negative carrying amounts. For those reporting units, an entity is required to perform Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test if it is more likely than not that a goodwill impairment exists. In determining whether it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists, an entity should consider whether there are any adverse qualitative factors indicating that impairment may exist. As a result, goodwill impairments may be reported sooner than under current practice. The guidance is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2010. The adoption of this accounting standard is not expected to have a material effect on the Company’s financial position or results of operations.

In January 2011, the FASB issued FASB ASU No. 2011-01 which defers the effective date of disclosures about troubled debt restructurings in FASB ASU No. 2010-20.  ASU No. 2011-01 temporarily deferred the effective date for disclosures related to troubled debt restructurings to coincide with the effective date of ASU No. 2011-02, which is effective for periods ending after June 15, 2011. The adoption of this accounting standard is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial position or results of operations.
 
In April 2011, the FASB issued FASB ASU No. 2011-02 regarding a creditor’s determination of a trouble debt restructure. This guidance will assist creditors in determining whether a creditor has granted a concession and whether a debtor is experiencing financial difficulties for purposes of determining whether a restructuring constitutes a troubled debt restructuring. The guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011.  The Company is currently assessing the impact this guidance will have on the Company’s financial position and results of operations

2.     
RESTRICTED ASSETS

Federal Reserve Board regulations require that the Bank maintain minimum reserve balances either on hand or on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”), based on a percentage of deposits. The amounts of such balances as of March 31, 2011 and 2010 were $773,000 and $726,000, respectively.

3.     
INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities held to maturity consisted of the following (in thousands):
 
 
Amortized Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Estimated Fair Value
March 31, 2011
                     
Municipal bonds
$
506
 
$
50
 
$
-
 
$
556
                       
March 31, 2010
                     
Municipal bonds
$
517
 
$
56
 
$
-
 
$
573

The contractual maturities of investment securities held to maturity are as follows (in thousands):
 
 
March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Estimated
Fair Value
 
Due in one year or less
$
-
 
$
-
 
Due after one year through five years
 
-
   
-
 
Due after five years through ten years
 
506
   
556
 
Due after ten years
 
-
   
-
 
Total
$
506
 
$
556
 


 
79 

 

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities available for sale consisted of the following (in thousands):
 
Amortized Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Estimated Fair Value
March 31, 2011
                     
Trust preferred
$
2,974
 
$
-
 
$
(2,058
)
$
916
Agency securities
 
5,000
   
-
   
(136
)
 
4,864
Municipal bonds
 
540
   
-
   
-
   
540
Total
$
8,514
 
$
-
 
$
(2,194
)
$
6,320
                       
March 31, 2010
                     
Trust preferred
$
2,974
 
$
-
 
$
(1,932
)
$
1,042
Agency securities
 
4,989
   
28
   
-
   
5,017
Municipal bonds
 
743
   
-
   
-
   
743
Total
$
8,706
 
$
28
 
$
(1,932
)
$
6,802

The fair value of temporarily impaired securities, the amount of unrealized losses and the length of time these unrealized losses existed as of March 31, 2011 are as follows (in thousands):

 
Less than 12 months
 
  12 months or longer
 
  Total
 
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
 
                                     
Trust preferred
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
916
 
$
(2,058
)
$
916
 
$
(2,058
)
Agency securities
 
4,864
   
(136
)
 
-
   
-
   
4,864
   
(136
)
Total
$
4,864
 
$
(136
)
$
916
 
$
(2,058
)
$
5,780
 
$
(2,194
)


The fair value of temporarily impaired securities, the amount of unrealized losses and the length of time these unrealized losses existed as of March 31, 2010 are as follows (in thousands):

 
Less than 12 months
 
  12 months or longer
 
  Total
 
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
   
Fair
Value
   
Unrealized
Losses
 
                                     
Trust preferred
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
1,042
 
$
(1,932
)
$
1,042
 
$
(1,932
)

At March 31, 2011, the Company had a single collateralized debt obligation which is secured by trust preferred securities issued by 19 other holding companies. The Company holds the mezzanine tranche of this security. Four of the issuers in this pool have defaulted (representing 37% of the remaining collateral), and eight others are currently in deferral (30% of the remaining collateral). The Company has estimated an expected default rate of 45% for the security. The expected default rate was estimated based primarily on an analysis of the financial condition of the underlying banks. There was no excess subordination on this security.
 
During the year ended March 31, 2011, the Company determined that there was no additional other than temporary impairment (“OTTI”) charge on the above trust preferred investment security. The Company does not intend to sell this security and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before the anticipated recovery of the remaining amortized cost basis.
 
To determine the component of gross OTTI related to credit losses, the Company compared the amortized cost basis of the OTTI security to the present value of the revised expected cash flows, discounted using the current pre-impairment yield.  The revised expected cash flow estimates are based primarily on an analysis of default rates, prepayment speeds and third-party analytical reports.  Significant judgment of management is required in this analysis that includes, but is not limited to, assumptions regarding the ultimate collectibility of principal and interest on the underlying collateral.
 
The unrealized losses on the above agency securities are primarily attributable to increases in market interest rates subsequent to their purchase by the Company.  The Company expects the fair value of these agency securities to recover as the agency securities approach their maturity dates or sooner if market yields for such securities decline.  The Company does not believe that any of the agency securities are impaired due to reasons of credit quality or related to any company or industry specific event.  Based on management’s evaluation and intent, none of the unrealized losses related to the agency securities in this table are considered other than temporary.
 
 
80

 
 
 
The contractual maturities of investment securities available for sale are as follows (in thousands):
 
 
March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Estimated
Fair Value
 
Due in one year or less
$
-
 
$
-
 
Due after one year through five years
 
5,000
   
4,864
 
Due after five years through ten years
 
-
   
-
 
Due after ten years
 
3,514
   
1,456
 
Total
$
8,514
 
$
6,320
 


There were no investment securities at March 31, 2011 pledged as collateral for treasury tax and loan funds held by the Bank. Investment securities with an amortized cost $499,000 and a fair value $502,000 at March 31, 2010 were pledged as collateral for treasury tax and loan funds held by the Bank. There were no investment securities at March 31, 2011 pledged as collateral for government public funds held by the Bank. Investment securities with an amortized cost of $2.8 million and a fair value of $2.9 million at March 31, 2010, were pledged as collateral for government public funds held by the Bank. The Company realized no gains or losses on sales of investment securities in the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

4.  
MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES

Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity consisted of the following (in thousands):
                         
March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
$
78
 
$
4
 
$
-
 
$
82
 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
 
112
   
5
   
-
   
117
 
Total
$
190
 
$
9
 
$
-
 
$
199
 
                         
March 31, 2010
                       
Real estate mortgage investment conduits
$
53
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
53
 
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
 
86
   
3
   
-
   
89
 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
 
120
   
3
   
-
   
123
 
Total
$
259
 
$
6
 
$
-
 
$
265
 

Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity with an amortized cost of $76,000 and $136,000 and a fair value of $80,000 and $138,000 at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged as collateral for governmental public funds. Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity with an amortized cost of $98,000 and $105,000 and a fair value of $103,000 and $107,000 at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged as collateral for treasury tax and loan funds held by the Bank. The real estate mortgage investment conduits consist of FHLMC and FNMA securities.

The contractual maturities of mortgage-backed securities classified as held to maturity are as follows (in thousands):

March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Estimated
Fair Value
Due in one year or less
$
-
 
$
-
Due after one year through five years
 
6
   
6
Due after five years through ten years
 
-
   
-
Due after ten years
 
184
   
193
Total
$
190
 
$
199

 

 
81 

 

Mortgage-backed securities available for sale consisted of the following (in thousands):
 
March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Real estate mortgage investment conduits
$
421
 
$
12
 
$
-
 
$
433
 
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
 
1,270
   
34
   
-
   
1,304
 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
 
38
   
2
   
-
   
40
 
Total
$
1,729
 
$
48
 
$
-
 
$
1,777
 
                         
March 31, 2010
                       
Real estate mortgage investment conduits
$
538
 
$
18
 
$
-
 
$
556
 
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
 
2,158
   
61
   
-
   
2,219
 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
 
50
   
3
   
-
   
53
 
Total
$
2,746
 
$
82
 
$
-
 
$
2,828
 

The contractual maturities of mortgage-backed securities available for sale are as follows (in thousands):
 
March 31, 2011
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Estimated
Fair Value
Due in one year or less
$
-
 
$
-
Due after one year through five years
 
1,288
   
1,324
Due after five years through ten years
 
140
   
147
Due after ten years
 
301
   
306
Total
$
1,729
 
$
1,777

Expected maturities of mortgage-backed securities held to maturity and available for sale will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to prepay obligations with or without prepayment penalties.

There were no mortgage-backed securities available for sale pledged as collateral for advances at the FHLB at March 31, 2011. Mortgage-backed securities available for sale with an amortized cost of $2.7 million and a fair value of $2.8 million at March 31, 2010, were pledged as collateral for advances at the FHLB.  Mortgage-backed securities available for sale with an amortized cost of $178,000 and $51,000 and a fair value of $187,000 and $53,000 at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, were pledged as collateral for government public funds held by the Bank. Mortgage-backed securities available for sale with an amortized cost of $128,000 and a fair value of $131,000 at March 31, 2011, were pledged as collateral for treasury tax and loan funds held by the Bank. There were no mortgage-backed securities available for sale pledged as collateral for treasury tax and loan funds at March 31, 2010.

5.     
LOANS RECEIVABLE

Loans receivable at March 31, 2011 and 2010 are reported net of deferred loan fees totaling $2.9 million and $3.0 million, respectively. Loans receivable, excluding loans held for sale, consisted of the following (in thousands):


   
March 31, 2011
   
March 31, 2010
Commercial and construction
         
Commercial business
$
85,511
 
$
108,368
Other real estate mortgage
 
461,955
   
459,178
Real estate construction
 
27,385
   
75,456
Total commercial and construction
 
574,851
   
643,002
           
Consumer
         
Real estate one-to-four family
 
110,437
   
88,861
Other installment
 
2,289
   
2,616
Total consumer
 
112,726
   
91,477
           
Total loans
 
687,577
   
734,479
           
Less:
         
Allowance for loan losses
 
14,968
   
21,642
Loans receivable, net
$
672,609
 
$
712,837
 
 
82

 
 
The Company originates commercial business, commercial real estate, multi-family real estate, real estate construction, residential real estate and consumer loans. At March 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had no loans to foreign domiciled businesses or foreign countries, or loans related to highly leveraged transactions. Substantially all of the mortgage loans in the Company’s portfolio are secured by properties located in Washington and Oregon, and, accordingly, the ultimate collectibility of a substantial portion of the Company’s loan portfolio is susceptible to changes in the local economic conditions in these markets. The Company considers its loan portfolio to have very little exposure to sub-prime mortgage loans since the Company has not historically engaged in this type of lending.

Aggregate loans to officers and directors, all of which are current, consist of the following (in thousands):


 
Year Ended March 31,
 
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Beginning balance
$
1,448
 
$
1,021
 
$
418
 
Originations
 
774
   
628
   
681
 
Principal repayments
 
(62
)
 
(201
)
 
(78
)
Ending balance
$
2,160
 
$
1,448
 
$
1,021
 

6.  
ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES

Allowance for loan loss: Commercial business, commercial real estate, construction and land acquisition loans are considered to have a higher degree of credit risk than one-to-four family residential loans, and tend to be more vulnerable to adverse conditions in the real estate market and deteriorating economic conditions. While the Company believes the estimates and assumptions used in its determination of the allowance are reasonable, there can be no assurance that such estimates and assumptions will not be proven incorrect in the future, that the actual amount of future provisions will not exceed the amount of past provisions, or that any increased provisions that may be required will not adversely impact our financial condition and results of operations. In addition, bank regulators periodically review the Company’s allowance and may require the Company to increase its provision for loan losses or recognize additional loan charge-offs. An increase in the Company’s allowance for loan losses or loan charge-offs as required by these regulatory authorities may have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of operations.

Management’s evaluation of the allowance for loan losses is based on ongoing, quarterly assessments of the known and inherent risks in the loan portfolio. Loss factors are based on the Company’s historical loss experience with additional consideration and adjustments made for changes in economic conditions, changes in the amount and composition of the loan portfolio, delinquency rates, changes in collateral values, seasoning of the loan portfolio, duration of current business cycle, a detailed analysis of impaired loans and other factors as deemed appropriate. These factors are evaluated on a quarterly basis. Loss rates used by the Company are affected as changes in these factors increase or decrease from quarter to quarter. The Company also considers bank regulatory examination results and findings of internal credit examiners in its quarterly evaluation of the allowance for loan losses. Management’s recent analysis of the allowance has placed greater emphasis on the Company’s construction and land development loan portfolios and the effect of various factors such as geographic and loan type concentrations. The Company has focused on managing these portfolios in an attempt to minimize the effects of declining home values and slower home sales in its market areas.

The following tables present a reconciliation of the allowance for loan losses (in thousands):

March 31, 2011
 
Commercial  
Business
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Land
   
Multi-Family
   
Real Estate Construction
   
Consumer
   
Unallocated
   
Total
 
                                                 
Beginning balance
$
3,181
 
$
4,592
 
$
5,013
 
$
423
 
$
5,137
 
$
1,574
 
$
1,722
 
$
21,642
 
Provision for loan losses
 
1,005
   
414
   
1,101
   
1,749
   
5
   
455
   
346
   
5,075
 
Charge-offs
 
(2,371
)
 
(263
)
 
(4,141
)
 
-
   
(4,329
)
 
(703
)
 
-
   
(11,807
)
Recoveries
 
7
   
1
   
30
   
-
   
7
   
13
   
-
   
58
 
Ending balance
$
1,822
 
$
4,744
 
$
2,003
 
$
2,172
 
$
820
 
$
1,339
 
$
2,068
 
$
14,968
 

March 31, 2010
 
Commercial  
Business
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Land
   
Multi-Family
   
Real Estate Construction
   
Consumer
   
Unallocated
   
Total
 
                                                 
Beginning balance
$
2,668
 
$
3,529
 
$
2,594
 
$
352
 
$
4,592
 
$
1,209
 
$
2,030
 
$
16,974
 
Provision for loan losses
 
2,973
   
1,099
   
6,219
   
71
   
4,206
   
1,640
   
(308
)
 
15,900
 
Charge-offs
 
(2,466
)
 
(36
)
 
(3,800
)
 
-
   
(3,737
)
 
(1,282
)
 
-
   
(11,321
)
Recoveries
 
6
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
76
   
7
   
-
   
89
 
Ending balance
$
3,181
 
$
4,592
 
$
5,013
 
$
423
 
$
5,137
 
$
1,574
 
$
1,722
 
$
21,642
 
 
 
 
83

 

 
March 31, 2009
 
Commercial  
Business
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Land
   
Multi-Family
   
Real Estate Construction
   
Consumer
   
Unallocated
   
Total
 
                                                 
Beginning balance
$
1,339
 
$
2,945
 
$
2,020
 
$
450
 
$
2,092
 
$
733
 
$
1,108
 
$
10,687
 
Provision for loan losses
 
2,498
   
584
   
6,484
   
21
   
4,573
   
1,068
   
922
   
16,150
 
Charge-offs
 
(1,192
)
 
-
   
(5,913
)
 
(119
)
 
(2,073
)
 
(593
)
 
-
   
(9,890
)
Recoveries
 
23
   
-
   
3
   
-
   
-
   
1
   
-
   
27
 
Ending balance
$
2,668
 
$
3,529
 
$
2,594
 
$
352
 
$
4,592
 
$
1,209
 
$
2,030
 
$
16,974
 

The following tables present an analysis of loans receivable and allowance for loan losses, which were evaluated individually and collectively for impairment at the dates indicated (in thousands):

 
Allowance for loan losses
 
Recorded investment in loans
 
March 31, 2011
 
Individually
Evaluated for
Impairment
   
Collectively
Evaluated for Impairment
   
Total
   
Individually
Evaluated for
Impairment
   
Collectively
Evaluated for
Impairment
   
Total
 
                                     
Commercial business
$
207
 
$
1,615
 
$
1,822
 
$
3,382
 
$
82,129
 
$
85,511
 
Commercial real estate
 
59
   
4,685
   
4,744
   
8,976
   
355,712
   
364,688
 
Land
 
-
   
2,003
   
2,003
   
2,695
   
52,563
   
55,258
 
Multi-family
 
1,779
   
393
   
2,172
   
8,000
   
34,009
   
42,009
 
Real estate construction
 
-
   
820
   
820
   
4,206
   
23,179
   
27,385
 
Consumer
 
-
   
1,339
   
1,339
   
-
   
112,726
   
112,726
 
Unallocated
 
-
   
2,068
   
2,068
   
-
   
-
   
-
 
Total
$
2,045
 
$
12,923
 
$
14,968
 
$
27,259
 
$
660,318
 
$
687,577
 

March 31, 2010
                                   
                                     
Commercial business
$
1,295
 
$
1,886
 
$
3,181
 
$
6,013
 
$
102,355
 
$
108,368
 
Commercial real estate
 
-
   
4,592
   
4,592
   
2,995
   
348,188
   
351,183
 
Land
 
2,647
   
2,366
   
5,013
   
11,740
   
63,039
   
74,779
 
Multi-family
 
-
   
423
   
423
   
-
   
33,216
   
33,216
 
Real estate construction
 
3,957
   
1,180
   
5,137
   
16,408
   
59,048
   
75,456
 
Consumer
 
135
   
1,439
   
1,574
   
624
   
90,853
   
91,477
 
Unallocated
 
-
   
1,722
   
1,722
   
-
   
-
   
-
 
Total
$
8,034
 
$
13,608
 
$
21,642
 
$
37,780
 
$
696,699
 
$
734,479
 

Changes in the allowance for unfunded loan commitments were as follows (in thousands):

 
Year Ended March 31,
 
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Beginning balance
$
185
 
$
296
 
$
337
 
Net change in allowance for unfunded loan commitments
 
(19
)
 
(111
)
 
(41
)
Ending balance
$
166
 
$
185
 
$
296
 

Non-accrual loans: The following tables present an analysis of past due loans at the dates indicated (in thousands):

March 31, 2011
 
30-89 Days
Past Due
   
Greater
Than 90
Days (Non-
Accrual)
   
Total Past
Due
   
Current
   
Total
Loans
Receivable
   
Recorded
Investment >
90 Days and
Accruing
                                   
Commercial business
$
1,415
 
$
2,871
 
$
4,286
 
$
81,225
 
$
85,511
 
$
-
Commercial real estate
 
2,112
   
1,385
   
3,497
   
361,191
   
364,688
   
-
Land
 
-
   
2,904
   
2,904
   
52,354
   
55,258
   
-
Multi-family
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
42,009
   
42,009
   
-
Real estate construction
 
-
   
4,206
   
4,206
   
23,179
   
27,385
   
-
Consumer
 
4,271
   
957
   
5,228
   
107,498
   
112,726
   
-
Total
$
7,798
 
$
12,323
 
$
20,121
 
$
667,456
 
$
687,577
 
$
-
 
 
 
84

 

 
March 31, 2010
 
30-89 Days
Past Due
   
Greater
Than 90
Days (Non-
Accrual)
   
Total Past
Due
   
Current
   
Total
Loans
Receivable
   
Recorded
Investment >
90 Days and
Accruing
                                   
Commercial business
$
1,147
 
$
6,430
 
$
7,577
 
$
100,791
 
$
108,368
 
$
-
Commercial real estate
 
3,186
   
2,996
   
6,182
   
345,001
   
351,183
   
-
Land
 
-
   
12,083
   
12,083
   
62,696
   
74,779
   
-
Multi-family
 
447
   
-
   
447
   
32,769
   
33,216
   
-
Real estate construction
 
7,201
   
11,826
   
19,027
   
56,429
   
75,456
   
-
Consumer
 
2,175
   
2,676
   
4,851
   
86,626
   
91,477
   
-
Total
$
14,156
 
$
36,011
 
$
50,167
 
$
684,312
 
$
734,479
 
$
-

Interest income foregone on non-accrual loans was $1.9 million $2.8 million and $2.0 million for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Credit quality indicators: The Company monitors credit risk in its loan portfolio using a risk rating system for all commercial (non-consumer) loans. The risk rating system is a measure of the credit risk of the borrower based on their historical, current and anticipated financial characteristics. The Company assigns a risk rating to each commercial loan at origination and subsequently updates these ratings, as necessary, so the risk rating continues to reflect the appropriate risk characteristics of the loan. Application of appropriate risk ratings is key to management of the loan portfolio risk. In arriving at the rating, the Company considers the following factors: delinquency, payment history, quality of management, liquidity, leverage, earning trends, alternative funding sources, geographic risk, industry risk, cash flow adequacy, account practices, asset protection and extraordinary risks. Consumer loans, including custom construction loans, are not assigned a risk rating but rather are grouped into homogeneous pools with similar risk characteristics. When a consumer loan is delinquent 90 days it is placed on non-accrual status and assigned a substandard risk rating. Loss factors are assigned to each risk rating and homogeneous pool based on historical loss experience for similar loans. This historical loss experience is adjusted for qualitative factors that are likely to cause the estimated credit losses to differ from the Company’s historical loss experience. The Company uses these loss factors to estimate the general component of its allowance for loan loss.

Pass - These loans have risk rating between 1 and 4 and are to borrowers that meet normal credit standards.  Any deficiencies in satisfactory asset quality, liquidity, debt servicing capacity and coverage are offset by strengths in other areas. The borrower currently has the capacity to perform according to the loan terms. Any concerns about risk factors such as stability of margins, stability of cash flows, liquidity, dependence on a single product/supplier/customer, depth of management, etc., are offset by strength in other areas. Typically, the operating assets of the company and/or real estate will secure these loans. Management is considered competent. The borrower has the ability to repay the debt in the normal course of business.

Watch – These loans have a risk rating of 5 and would typically have many of the attributes of loans in the pass rating. However, there would typically be some reason for additional management oversight, such as recent financial setbacks, deteriorating financial position, industry concerns and failure to perform on other borrowing obligations. Loans with this rating are to be monitored closely in an effort to correct deficiencies.

Special mention – These loans have a risk rating of 6 and are currently protected but have the potential to deteriorate to a “Substandard” rating. The borrower’s financial performance may be inconsistent or below forecast, creating the possibility of liquidity problems and shrinking debt service coverage. The borrower may have a short track record and little depth of management. Other typical characteristics include inadequate current financial information, marginal capitalization, and susceptibility to negative industry trends. The primary source of repayment is still viable but there is increasing reliance on collateral or guarantor support.
 
Substandard – These loans have a risk rating of 7 and are rated in accordance with regulatory guidelines, for which the accrual of interest may or may not be discontinued. By definition under regulatory guidelines, a “Substandard” loan has defined weaknesses which make payment default or principal exposure likely, but not yet certain. Such loans are apt to be dependent upon collateral liquidation, a secondary source of repayment, or an event outside of the normal course of business.
 
Doubtful - These loans have a risk rating of 8 and are rated in accordance with regulatory guidelines. Such loans are placed on nonaccrual status and may be dependent upon collateral having a value that is difficult to determine or upon some near-term event which lacks certainty.
 
 
85

 
 

Loss - These loans have a risk rating of 9 and are rated in accordance with regulatory guidelines. Such loans are to be charged-off or charged-down when payment is acknowledged to be uncertain or when the timing or value of payments cannot be determined. “Loss” is not intended to imply that the loan or some portion of it will never be paid, nor does it in any way imply that there has been a forgiveness of debt.

The following tables present an analysis of credit quality indicators at the dates indicated (dollars in thousands):
 
 
March 31, 2011
   
March 31, 2010
   
Weighted-
Average Risk
Grade
   
Classified
Loans
     
Weighted-
Average
Risk Grade
   
Classified
Loans
                         
Commercial Business
 
4.00
 
$
4,920
     
3.95
 
$
9,705
Commercial Real Estate
 
3.66
   
8,909
     
3.59
   
3,057
Land
 
5.00
   
8,818
     
5.18
   
19,211
Multi-Family
 
4.06
   
4,679
     
3.58
   
4
Real estate Construction
 
4.96
   
8,106
     
4.76
   
17,519
Consumer (1)
 
7.00
   
957
     
7.00
   
2,749
Total
 
3.93
 
$
36,389
     
3.98
 
$
52,245
                         
Total loans risk rated
$
573,506
         
$
640,928
     
                         
  (1) Consumer loans are primarily evaluated on a homogenous pool level and generally not individually risk rated unless certain factors are met.

Impaired loans: The following tables present an analysis of impaired loans at the dates indicated (in thousands):

March 31, 2011
 
Recorded
Investment with
No Specific
Valuation
Allowance
   
Recorded
Investment
with Specific
Valuation
Allowance
   
Total
Recorded
Investment
   
Unpaid
Principal
Balance
   
Related
Specific
Valuation
Allowance
   
Average
Recorded
Investment
                                   
Commercial business
$
1,024
 
$
2,358
 
$
3,382
 
$
5,562
 
$
207
 
$
5,593
Commercial real estate
 
750
   
8,226
   
8,976
   
9,221
   
59
   
9,979
Land
 
2,695
   
-
   
2,695
   
5,094
   
-
   
6,695
Multi-family
 
-
   
8,000
   
8,000
   
8,036
   
1,779
   
3,864
Real estate construction
 
4,206
   
-
   
4,206
   
8,474
   
-
   
10,950
Consumer
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
462
Total
$
8,675
 
$
18,584
 
$
27,259
 
$
36,387
 
$
2,045
 
$
37,543
                                   
March 31, 2010                                   
Commercial business
$
1,138
 
$
4,875
 
$
6,013
 
$
7,200
 
$
1,295
 
$
5,759
Commercial real estate
 
2,995
   
-
   
2,995
   
3,137
   
-
   
2,677
Land
 
3,569
   
8,171
   
11,740
   
16,331
   
2,647
   
11,359
Multi-family
 
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
   
-
Real estate construction
 
-
   
16,408
   
16,408
   
18,491
   
3,957
   
16,054
Consumer
 
-
   
624
   
624
   
648
   
135
   
552
Total
$
7,702
 
$
30,078
 
$
37,780
 
$
45,807
 
$
8,034
 
$
36,401

The related amount of interest income recognized on loans that were impaired was $907,000, $175,000 and $373,000 during the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

At March 31, 2011, the Company had trouble debt restructurings totaling $5.9 million, which were on accrual status. There were no trouble debt restructurings at March 31, 2010.


 
86 

 

7.     
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

Premises and equipment consisted of the following (in thousands):

 
   March 31,
 
   
2011
     
2010
 
               
Land
$
3,213
   
$
3,213
 
Buildings and improvements
 
11,968
     
11,941
 
Leasehold improvements
 
1,413
     
1,413
 
Furniture and equipment
 
9,985
     
10,091
 
Buildings under capitalized leases
 
2,715
     
2,715
 
Construction in progress
 
690
     
-
 
Total
 
29,984
     
29,373
 
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization
 
(13,884
)
   
(12,886
)
Premises and equipment, net
$
16,100
   
$
16,487
 

Depreciation expense was $1.5 million, $1.7 million and $1.8 million for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The Company is obligated under various noncancellable lease agreements for land and buildings that require future minimum rental payments, exclusive of taxes and other charges.

During fiscal year 2006, the Company entered into a capital lease for the shell of the building constructed as the Company’s operations center. The lease period is for twelve years with two six-year lease renewal options. For the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company recorded $113,000 in amortization expense. At March 31, 2011 and 2010, accumulated amortization for the capital lease totaled $601,000 and $488,000, respectively.

In March 2010, the Company sold two of its branch locations. The Company maintains a substantial continuing involvement in the locations through various non-cancellable operating leases that contain certain renewal options. The resulting gain on sale of $2.1 million was deferred and is being amortized over the life of the respective leases. At March 31, 2011, the deferred gain was $2.0 million and is included in accrued expenses and other liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets.

The following is a schedule of future minimum lease payments under capital leases together with the present value of net minimum lease payments and the future minimum rental payments required under operating leases that have initial or noncancellable lease terms in excess of one year as of March 31, 2011 (in thousands):

Year Ending March 31:
 
Operating Lease
     
Capital Lease
 
2012
$
1,725
   
$
236
 
2013
 
1,761
     
251
 
2014
 
1,655
     
251
 
2015
 
1,573
     
251
 
2016
 
1,589
     
251
 
Thereafter
 
6,255
     
3,432
 
Total minimum lease payments
$
14,558
     
4,672
 
Less amount representing interest
         
(2,105
)
Present value of net minimum lease
       
$
2,567
 


Rent expense was $1.8 million, $1.7 million and $1.8 million for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

8.     
REAL ESTATE OWNED

The following table is a summary of the activity in REO for the periods indicated (in thousands):

 
Year Ended March 31,
 
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Balance at beginning of year, net
$
13,325
 
$
14,171
 
$
494
 
Additions
 
22,822
   
19,644
   
14,666
 
Dispositions
 
(7,633
)
 
(15,696
)
 
(889
)
Writedowns
 
(924
)
 
(4,794
)
 
(100
)
Balance at end of year, net
$
27,590
 
$
13,325
 
$
14,171
 
 
 
87

 

 
REO expenses for the year ended March 31, 2011 consisted of write-downs on existing REO properties of $924,000 and operating expenses of $893,000. Net gains on dispositions of REO totaled $386,000 for the year ended March 31, 2011, and were included in other non-interest income in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations. REO expenses for the year ended March 31, 2010 consisted of write-downs on existing REO properties of $4.8 million, operating expenses of $726,000 and losses on dispositions of REO of $902,000. REO expenses for the year ended March 31, 2009 consisted of operating expense of $113,000, write-downs on existing REO properties of $100,000 and losses on dispositions of REO of $104,000.

9.     
GOODWILL

Goodwill and intangibles generally arise from business combinations accounted for under the purchase method.  Goodwill and other intangibles deemed to have indefinite lives generated from purchase business combinations are not subject to amortization and are instead tested for impairment no less than annually.  The Company has one reporting unit, the Bank, for purposes of computing goodwill.
 
During the third quarter of fiscal 2011, the Company performed its annual goodwill impairment test to determine whether an impairment of its goodwill asset exists. The goodwill impairment test involves a two-step process. The first step is a comparison of the reporting unit’s fair value to its carrying value. If the reporting unit’s fair value is less than its carrying value, the Company would be required to progress to the second step. In the second step the Company calculates the implied fair value of goodwill. The GAAP standards with respect to goodwill require that the Company compare the implied fair value of goodwill to the carrying amount of goodwill on the Company’s balance sheet.  If the carrying amount of the goodwill is greater than the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss must be recognized in an amount equal to that excess. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as goodwill recognized in a business combination. The estimated fair value of the Company is allocated to all of the Company’s individual assets and liabilities, including any unrecognized identifiable intangible assets, as if the Company had been acquired in a business combination and the estimated fair value of the Company is the price paid to acquire it. The allocation process is performed only for purposes of determining the amount of goodwill impairment, as no assets or liabilities are written up or down, nor are any additional unrecognized identifiable intangible assets recorded as a part of this process. The results of the Company’s step one test indicated that the reporting unit’s fair value was less than its carrying value and therefore the Company performed a step two analysis.  After the step two analysis was completed, the Company determined the implied fair value of goodwill was greater than the carrying value on the Company’s balance sheet and no goodwill impairment existed; however, no assurance can be given that the Company’s goodwill will not be written down in future periods.

An interim impairment test was not deemed necessary as of March 31, 2011, due to there not being a significant change in the reporting unit’s assets and liabilities, the amount that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeded the carrying value as of the most recent valuation, and because the Company determined that, based on an analysis of events that have occurred and circumstances that have changed since the most recent valuation date, the likelihood that a current fair value determination would be less than the current carrying amount of the reporting unit is remote.

10.    
DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS

Deposit accounts consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):

Account Type
Weighted Average Rate
     
March 31, 2011
 
Weighted Average Rate
     
March 31, 2010
 
Non-interest-bearing
0.00
%
 
$
102,429
 
0.00
%
 
$
83,794
 
Interest checking
0.18
     
77,399
 
0.34
     
70,837
 
Money market
0.60
     
236,321
 
1.04
     
209,580
 
Savings accounts
0.35
     
37,231
 
0.55
     
32,131
 
Certificates of deposit
1.30
     
263,150
 
1.86
     
291,706
 
Total
0.71
%
 
$
716,530
 
1.16
%
 
$
688,048
 

The weighted average rate is based on interest rates at the end of the year.

Certificates of deposit in amounts of $100,000 or more totaled $165.1 million and $179.2 million at March 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.


 
88 

 

Interest expense by deposit type was as follows (in thousands):

 
Year Ended March 31,
 
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Interest checking
$
239
 
$
331
 
$
983
 
Money market
 
1,846
   
2,360
   
3,810
 
Savings accounts
 
160
   
162
   
149
 
Certificate of deposit
 
4,324
   
6,782
   
10,337
 
Total
$
6,569
 
$
9,635
 
$
15,279
 

11.   
FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK ADVANCES

At March 31, 2011, there were no advances outstanding from the FHLB.  Advances from the FHLB totaled $23.0 million with a weighted average interest rate of 0.64% at March 31, 2010.  The FHLB borrowings at March 31, 2010 consisted of two $10.0 million fixed rate advance and a Cash Management Advance with a rate set daily by the FHLB.  The weighted average interest rate for fixed and adjustable rate advances was 0.73%, 1.07%, and 1.99% for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

The Bank has a credit line with the FHLB equal to 30% of total assets, limited by available collateral. At March 31, 2011, based on collateral values, the Bank had additional borrowing capacity of $204.0 million from the FHLB. FHLB advances are collateralized as provided for in the Advance, Pledge and Security Agreements with the FHLB by certain investment and mortgage-backed securities, FHLB stock owned by the Bank, deposits with the FHLB, and certain mortgages on deeds of trust securing such properties as provided in the agreements with the FHLB. At March 31, 2011, loans carried at $306.1 million were pledged as collateral to the FHLB.

12.   
FEDERAL RESERVE BANK BORROWINGS

The Company has a borrowing arrangement with the FRB with an available credit facility of $107.9 million, subject to pledged collateral.  As of March 31, 2011, the Company had no outstanding borrowings with the FRB.  At March 31, 2011, loans carried at $194.3 million were pledged as collateral to the FRB. At March 31, 2010, the Company had outstanding borrowings of $10.0 million with the FRB.  The weighted average interest rate for these advances was 0.50%.

13.   
JUNIOR SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES

At March 31, 2011, the Company had two wholly-owned subsidiary grantor trusts that were established for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities and common securities. The trust preferred securities accrue and pay distributions periodically at specified annual rates as provided in each trust agreement. The trusts used the net proceeds from each of the offerings to purchase a like amount of junior subordinated debentures (the “Debentures”) of the Company. The Debentures are the sole assets of the trusts.  The Company’s obligations under the Debentures and related documents, taken together, constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the Company of the obligations of the trusts. The trust preferred securities are mandatorily redeemable upon maturity of the Debentures, or upon earlier redemption as provided in the indentures.  The Company has the right to redeem the Debentures in whole or in part on or after specific dates, at a redemption price specified in the indentures governing the Debentures plus any accrued but unpaid interest to the redemption date. The Company also has the right to defer the payment of interest on each of the Debentures for a period not to exceed 20 consecutive quarters, provided that the deferral period does not extend beyond the stated maturity. During such deferral period, distributions on the corresponding trust preferred securities will also be deferred and the Company may not pay cash dividends to the holders of shares of our common stock. Beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2011, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on its outstanding $22.7 million aggregate principal amount of the Debentures. The Company continued with the interest deferral at March 31, 2011. As of March 31, 2011, the Company has deferred a total of $1.3 million of interest payments. During the deferral period, the Company is restricted from paying dividends on its common stock.

The Debentures issued by the Company to the grantor trusts, totaling $22.7 million, are reflected in the consolidated balance sheets in the liabilities section, under the caption “junior subordinated debentures.”  The common securities issued by the grantor trusts were purchased by the Company, and the Company’s investment in the common securities of $681,000 at March 31, 2011 and 2010, is included in prepaid expenses and other assets in the consolidated balance sheets.  The Company records interest expense on the Debentures in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 

 
89 

 

The following table is a summary of the terms of the current Debentures at March 31, 2011:

Issuance Trust
 
Issuance Date
 
Amount Outstanding
 
Rate Type
 
Initial Rate
 
Rate
 
Maturing Date
   
(Dollars in thousands)
Riverview Bancorp Statutory Trust I
 
  12/2005
 
  $    7,217
 
Variable (1)
 
5.88%
 
1.67%
 
3/2036
Riverview Bancorp Statutory Trust II
 
    6/2007
 
    15,464
 
Fixed (2)
 
7.03%
 
7.03%
 
9/2037
       
$  22,681
               
 
(1) The trust preferred securities reprice quarterly based on the three-month LIBOR plus 1.36%.
 
(2) The trust preferred securities bear a fixed quarterly interest rate for 60 months, at which time the rate begins to float on a quarterly basis based on the three-month LIBOR plus 1.35% until maturity.

14.   
INCOME TAXES

Income tax provision (benefit) for the years ended March 31 consisted of the following (in thousands):

 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Current
$
324
 
$
18
 
$
2,091
 
Deferred
 
1,841
   
(3,295
)
 
(3,653
)
Total
$
2,165
 
$
(3,277
)
$
(1,562
)

The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities at March 31, 2011 and 2010 are as follows (in thousands):

 
2011
 
2010
 
Deferred tax assets:
           
Deferred compensation
$
469
 
$
624
 
Loan loss reserve
 
5,373
   
7,749
 
Accrued expenses
 
265
   
199
 
Accumulated depreciation
 
518
   
410
 
Deferred gain on sale
 
460
   
522
 
Net unrealized loss on securities available for sale
 
730
   
620
 
Impairment on investment security
 
233
   
233
 
REO expense
 
2,833
   
2,286
 
Non-compete
 
119
   
132
 
Other
 
205
   
216
 
Total deferred tax asset
 
11,205
   
12,991
 

Deferred tax liabilities:
           
FHLB stock dividend
 
(1,063
)
 
(1,063
)
Purchase accounting
 
(79
)
 
(112
)
Prepaid expense
 
(167
)
 
(122
)
Loan fees/costs
 
(449
)
 
(517
)
Total deferred tax liability
 
(1,758
)
 
(1,814
)
Deferred tax asset, net
$
9,447
 
$
11,177
 

A reconciliation of the Company’s effective income tax rate with the federal statutory tax rate for the years ended March 31 is as follows:

     2011     2010      2009  
Statutory federal income tax rate
 
34.0
%
 
34.0
%
 
34.0
%
State and local income tax rate
 
1.5
   
1.5
   
1.5
 
ESOP market value adjustment
 
(0.2
)
 
0.1
   
(0.3
)
Interest income on municipal securities
 
(0.3
)
 
0.4
   
1.2
 
Bank owned life insurance
 
(3.3
)
 
2.5
   
4.8
 
Other, net
 
1.7
   
(0.9
)
 
(4.1
)
Effective federal income tax rate
 
33.4
%
 
37.6
%
 
37.1
%

There were no taxes related to the gains on sales of securities for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009. The tax effects of certain tax benefits related to stock options are recorded directly to shareholders’ equity.
 
 
90

 

The Bank’s retained earnings at March 31, 2011 and 2010 include base year bad debt reserves, which amounted to $2.2 million, for which no federal income tax liability has been recognized.  The amount of unrecognized deferred tax liability at March 31, 2011 and 2010 was $781,000.  This represents the balance of bad debt reserves created for tax purposes as of December 31, 1987.  These amounts are subject to recapture in the unlikely event that the Company’s banking subsidiaries (1) make distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits, as calculated for federal tax purposes, (2) redeem their stock, or (3) liquidate.  Management does not expect this temporary difference to reverse in the foreseeable future.

At March 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company had no unrecognized tax benefits or uncertain tax positions. In addition, the Company had no accrued interest or penalties as of March 31, 2011 or 2010. It is the Company’s policy to recognize potential accrued interest and penalties as a component of income tax expense. The Company is subject to U.S. federal income tax and income tax of the State of Oregon. The years 2007 to 2010 remain open to examination for federal income taxes, and years 2006 to 2010 remain open to State examination.

In accordance with current accounting guidance, a valuation allowance is required to be recognized if it is “more likely than not” that all or a portion of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. “More likely than not” is defined as greater than 50% probability of occurrence. A determination as to the ultimate realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent upon management’s judgment and evaluation of both positive and negative evidence, forecasts of future taxable income, applicable tax planning strategies, and an assessment of current and future economic and business conditions. Positive evidence reviewed included long-term earnings history prior to recent economic downturn, recent improved performance trends, proven ability to utilize deferred tax credits, projection of future income, capital levels and net operating loss carryback availability. Negative evidence reviewed included the losses sustained by the Company during fiscal years 2010 and 2009.

After considering both the positive and negative factors, management believes it has sufficient positive indicators to outweigh the negative factors and therefore believes it is more likely than not that we will be able to fully realize all of the recorded deferred tax assets. Accordingly, the Company did not establish a valuation allowance for deferred tax assets at March 31, 2011 or 2010 as the Company believes it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will be realized principally through future reversals of existing temporary differences and based on projections of future taxable income from operations.

15.   
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

Retirement Plan - The Riverview Bancorp, Inc. Employees’ Savings and Profit Sharing Plan (the “Plan”) is a defined contribution profit-sharing plan incorporating the provisions of Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code.  The Plan covers all employees with at least six months and 500 hours of service who are over the age of 18. The Company matches the employee’s elective contribution up to 4% of the employee’s compensation. Company expenses related to the Plan for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 were $399,000, $401,000 and $432,000, respectively.

Directors Deferred Compensation Plan - Directors may elect to defer their monthly directors’ fees until retirement with no income tax payable by the director until retirement benefits are received.  Chairman, President, Executive and Senior Vice Presidents of the Company may also defer salary into this plan. This alternative is made available to them through a nonqualified deferred compensation plan. The Company accrues annual interest on the unfunded liability under the Directors Deferred Compensation Plan based upon a formula relating to gross revenues, which amounted to 5.00%, 5.13% and 6.19% for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The estimated liability under the plan is accrued as earned by the participant. At March 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company’s aggregate liability under the plan was $1.3 million and $1.8 million, respectively.

Stock Option Plans - In July 1998, shareholders of the Company approved the adoption of the 1998 Stock Option Plan (“1998 Plan”). The 1998 Plan was effective October 1, 1998 and terminated on October 1, 2008.  Accordingly, no further option awards may be granted under the 1998 Plan; however, any awards granted prior to its expiration remain outstanding subject to their terms.  Under the 1998 Plan, the Company had the ability to grant both incentive and non-qualified stock options to purchase up to 714,150 shares of its common stock to officers, directors and employees. Each option granted under the 1998 Plan has an exercise price equal to the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the date of the grant, a maximum term of ten years and a vesting period from zero to five years.

In July 2003, shareholders of the Company approved the adoption of the 2003 Stock Option Plan (“2003 Plan”).  The 2003 Plan was effective July 2003 and will expire on the tenth anniversary of the effective date, unless terminated sooner by the Board.  Under the 2003 Plan, the Company may grant both incentive and non-qualified stock options to
 
 
91

 
 
purchase up to 458,554 shares of its common stock to officers, directors and employees.  Each option granted under the 2003 Plan has an exercise price equal to the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant, a maximum term of ten years and a vesting period from zero to five years. At March 31, 2011, there were options for 75,154 shares of the Company’s common stock available for future grant under the 2003 Plan.

The fair value of each stock option granted is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes based stock option valuation model. The fair value of all awards is amortized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service periods, which are generally the vesting periods. The Black-Scholes model uses the assumptions listed in the table below.  The expected life of options granted represents the period of time that they are expected to be outstanding. The expected life is determined based on historical experience with similar options, giving consideration to the contractual terms and vesting schedules. Expected volatility was estimated at the date of grant based on the historical volatility of the Company's common stock. Expected dividends are based on dividend trends and the market value of the Company's common stock at the time of grant. The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant. The Company granted 21,000, 122,000 and 38,500 stock options during the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

   
Risk Free
Interest Rate
 
Expected
Life (yrs)
 
Expected
Volatility
 
Expected
Dividends
                 
Fiscal 2011
 
2.50%
 
6.25
 
45.05%
 
2.77%
Fiscal 2010
 
3.08%
 
6.25
 
37.55%
 
2.45%
Fiscal 2009
 
2.99%
 
6.25
 
20.20%
 
2.77%

The weighted average grant-date fair value of fiscal years 2011, 2010 and 2009 awards were $0.85, $1.22 and $1.09, respectively.  As of March 31, 2011, unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested stock options totaled $16,000.  The Company recognized pre-tax compensation expense related to stock options of $77,000, $112,000 and $38,000 for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

The following table presents the activity related to options under all plans for the years indicated.

   
Year Ended March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Number of
Shares
   
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
   
Number of
Shares
   
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
   
Number of
Shares
   
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 
Balance, beginning of period
    465,700     $ 9.35       371,696     $ 10.99       424,972     $ 11.02  
Grants
    21,000       2.39       122,000       3.82       38,500       6.30  
Options exercised
    -       -       -       -       (10,000 )     4.70  
Forfeited
    (18,000 )     10.26       (8,000 )     10.82       (48,000 )     11.71  
Expired
    -       -       (19,996 )     5.50       (33,776 )     6.88  
Balance, end of period
    468,700     $ 9.00       465,700     $ 9.35       371,696     $ 10.99  

Additional information regarding options outstanding as of March 31, 2011 is as follows:
`
       
Options Outstanding
 
Options Exercisable
   
Weighted Avg
       
Weighted
       
Weighted
   
Remaining
       
Average
       
Average
Range of
 
Contractual
 
Number
   
Exercise
 
Number
   
Exercise
Exercise Price
 
Life (years)
 
Outstanding
   
Price
 
Exercisable
   
Price
                         
$1.97 - $6.17
 
8.42
 
179,000
 
$
4.13
 
162,200
 
$
4.31
$6.51 - $6.88
 
1.10
 
20,000
   
6.76
 
20,000
   
6.76
$7.49 - $9.51
 
2.46
 
33,700
   
8.45
 
32,700
   
8.46
$10.10 - $10.83
 
5.66
 
9,000
   
10.37
 
8,000
   
10.39
$12.98 - $14.52
 
5.05
 
227,000
   
13.08
 
224,000
   
13.06
   
5.99
 
468,700
 
$
9.00
 
446,900
 
$
9.22


 
92 

 

The following table presents information on stock options outstanding for the periods shown, less estimated forfeitures.

 
Year Ended
March 31, 2011
 
Year Ended
March 31, 2010
Stock options fully vested and expected to vest:
             
Number
 
466,525
     
458,475
 
Weighted average exercise price
$
9.01
   
$
9.42
 
Aggregate intrinsic value (1)
$
-
   
$
-
 
Weighted average contractual term of options (years)
 
5.98
     
6.69
 
Stock options fully vested and currently exercisable:
             
Number
 
446,900
     
334,200
 
Weighted average exercise price
$
9.22
   
$
11.28
 
Aggregate intrinsic value (1)
$
-
   
$
-
 
Weighted average contractual term of options (years)
 
5.85
     
5.70
 
               
 (1)  The aggregate intrinsic value of a stock options in the table above represents the total pre-tax intrinsic value (the amount by which the current market value of the underlying stock exceeds the exercise price) that would have been received by the option holders had all option holders exercised.  This amount changes based on changes in the market value of the Company’s stock.

There were no stock options exercised for the years ended March 31, 2011 and 2010.  The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised was $31,000 for the year ended March 31 2009.

16.  
EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN

The Company sponsors an ESOP that covers all employees with at least one year and 1,000 hours of service who are over the age of 21.  Shares are released and allocated to participant accounts on December 31 of each year until 2017. ESOP compensation expense included in salaries and employee benefits was $64,000, $73,000 and $43,000 for years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

ESOP share activity is summarized in the following table:


 
Fair Value
of
Unreleased
Shares
 
Unreleased
ESOP
Shares
 
Allocated
and Released
Shares
 
Total
                 
Balance, March 31, 2008
$
2,458,000
 
246,330
 
716,254
 
962,584
Allocation December 31, 2008
     
(24,633
)
24,633
 
-
Balance, March 31, 2009
$
858,000
 
221,697
 
740,887
 
962,584
Allocation December 31, 2009
     
(24,633
)
24,633
 
-
Balance, March 31, 2010
$
453,000
 
197,064
 
765,520
 
962,584
Allocation December 31, 2010
     
(24,633
)
24,633
 
-
Balance, March 31, 2011
$
524,000
 
172,431
 
790,153
 
962,584

17.   
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS

The Company’s articles of incorporation authorize 250,000 shares of serial preferred stock.  No preferred shares were issued or outstanding at March 31, 2011 or 2010.

The Bank is subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”). Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Bank’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.  The Bank’s capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios of total and tier I capital to risk-weighted assets, core capital to total assets and tangible capital to tangible assets (set forth in the table below). Management believes the Bank meets all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject as of March 31, 2011.
 
 
93

 

As of March 31, 2011, the most recent notification from the OTS categorized the Bank as “well capitalized” under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as “well capitalized,” the Bank must maintain minimum total capital and tier I capital to risk weighted assets, core capital to total assets and tangible capital to tangible assets (set forth in the table below).

The Bank’s actual and required minimum capital amounts and ratios are as follows (dollars in thousands):

   
Actual
   
For Capital
Adequacy
Purposes
   
“Well Capitalized”
Under Prompt
Corrective Action
 
   
Amount
 
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
March 31, 2011
                             
Total Capital:
                             
(To Risk-Weighted Assets)
$
101,002
 
14.61
%
$
55,312
 
8.0
%
$
69,140
 
10.0
%
Tier 1 Capital:
                             
(To Risk-Weighted Assets)
 
92,307
 
13.35
   
27,656
 
4.0
   
41,484
 
6.0
 
Tier 1 Capital (Leverage):
                             
(To Adjusted Tangible Assets)
 
92,307
 
11.24
   
32,845
 
4.0
   
41,056
 
5.0
 
Tangible Capital:
                             
(To Tangible Assets)
 
92,307
 
11.24
   
12,317
 
1.5
   
N/A
 
N/A
 


March 31, 2010
                             
Total Capital:
                             
(To Risk-Weighted Assets)
$
89,048
 
12.11
%
$
58,835
 
8.0
%
$
73,544
 
10.0
%
Tier 1 Capital:
                             
(To Risk-Weighted Assets)
 
79,801
 
10.85
   
29,417
 
4.0
   
44,126
 
6.0
 
Tier 1 Capital (Leverage):
                             
(To Adjusted Tangible Assets)
 
79,801
 
9.84
   
32,453
 
4.0
   
40,566
 
5.0
 
Tangible Capital:
                             
(To Tangible Assets)
 
79,801
 
9.84
   
12,170
 
1.5
   
N/A
 
N/A
 

At periodic intervals, the OTS and the FDIC routinely examine the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements as part of their legally prescribed oversight of the savings and loan industry. Based on their examinations, these regulators can direct that the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements be adjusted in accordance with their findings. A future examination by the OTS or the FDIC could include a review of certain transactions or other amounts reported in the Company’s 2011 Consolidated Financial Statements.

The Company did not repurchase any shares of common stock for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 or 2009.

18.   
EARNINGS PER SHARE

Basic earning per share (“EPS”) is computed by dividing net income applicable to common stock by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, without considering any dilutive items. Diluted EPS is computed by dividing net income applicable to common stock by the weighted average number of common shares and common stock equivalents for items that are dilutive, net of shares assumed to be repurchased using the treasury stock method at the average share price for the Company’s common stock during the period. Common stock equivalents arise from assumed conversion of outstanding stock options. ESOP shares are not considered outstanding for EPS purposes until they are committed to be released. For the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, stock options for 465,000, 414,000 and 385,000 shares, respectively, of common stock were excluded in computing diluted EPS because they were antidilutive.

 
94 

 


 
Years Ended March 31,
 
(Dollars and share data in thousands, except per share data)
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Basic EPS computation:
                 
Numerator-net income (loss)
$
4,315
 
$
(5,444
)
$
(2,650
)
Denominator-weighted average
common shares outstanding
 
18,341
   
10,721
   
10,694
 
Basic EPS
$
0.24
 
$
(0.51
)
$
(0.25
)
Diluted EPS computation:
                 
Numerator-net income (loss)
$
4,315
 
$
(5,444
)
$
(2,650
)
Denominator-weighted average
common shares outstanding
 
18,341
   
10,721
   
10,694
 
Effect of dilutive stock options
 
-
   
-
   
-
 
Weighted average common shares
                 
and common stock equivalents (1)
 
18,341
   
10,721
   
10,694
 
Diluted EPS
$
0.24
 
$
(0.51
)
$
(0.25
)
 (1) For the years ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company recognized a net loss and therefore all outstanding stock options were excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share because they were antidilutive.

19.  
FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENT

The Fair Value Measurements and Disclosure topic of the FASB Accounting Standards Codification defines fair value and establishes a framework for measuring fair value in GAAP, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements.  The following definitions describe the categories used in the tables presented under fair value measurement.
 
Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets (Level 1): Inputs that are quoted unadjusted prices in active markets for identical assets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date.  An active market for the asset is a market in which transactions for the asset or liability occur with sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis.

Other observable inputs (Level 2): Inputs that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the reporting entity including quoted prices for similar assets, quoted prices for securities in inactive markets and inputs derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.

Significant unobservable inputs (Level 3): Inputs that reflect the reporting entity's own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances.

Financial instruments are broken down in the tables that follow by recurring or nonrecurring measurement status.  Recurring assets are initially measured at fair value and are required to be remeasured at fair value in the financial statements at each reporting date. Assets measured on a nonrecurring basis are assets that, as a result of an event or circumstance, were required to be remeasured at fair value after initial recognition in the financial statements at some time during the reporting period.

The following tables present assets that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis (in thousands).
 
     
    
Fair value measurements at March 31, 2011, using
 
 
Fair value
 
Quoted prices in
active markets
for identical assets
 
Other
observable
inputs
 
Significant
unobservable
inputs
 
March 31, 2011
 
(Level 1)
 
(Level 2)
 
(Level 3)
Investment securities available for sale
                     
Trust preferred
$
916
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
916
Agency securities
 
4,864
   
-
   
4,864
   
-
Municipal bonds
 
540
   
-
   
540
   
-
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale
                     
Real estate mortgage investment conduits
 
433
   
-
   
433
   
-
FHLMC mortgage-backed securities
 
1,304
   
-
   
1,304
   
-
FNMA mortgage-backed securities
 
40
   
-
   
40
   
-
                       
Total recurring assets measured at fair value
$
8,097
 
$
-
 
$
7,181
 
$
916
 
 
95

 

 
The following table presents a reconciliation of assets that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) during the year ended March 31, 2011 (in thousands). There were no transfers of assets in to or out of Level 3 for the year ended March 31, 2011.
 
   
For the Year Ended March 31, 2011
 
       
Balance at March 31, 2010
$
1,042
 
Transfers in to Level 3
 
-
 
Included in earnings (1)
 
-
 
Included in other comprehensive income
 
(126
)
Balance at March 31, 2011
$
916
 
       
(1) Included in other non-interest income
     
       
The following method was used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instrument above:

Investments and Mortgage-Backed Securities – Investment securities available-for-sale are included within Level 1 of the hierarchy when quoted prices in an active market for identical assets are available. The Company uses a third party pricing service to assist the Company in determining the fair value of its Level 2 securities, which incorporates pricing models and/or quoted prices of investment securities with similar characteristics. Our Level 3 assets consist of a single pooled trust preferred security.

The Company has determined that the market for its single trust preferred pooled security was inactive. This determination was made by the Company after considering the last known trade date for this specific security, the low number of transactions for similar types of securities, the low number of new issuances for similar securities, the significant increase in the implied liquidity risk premium for similar securities, the lack of information that is released publicly and discussions with third-party industry analysts. Due to the inactivity in the market, observable market data was not readily available for all significant inputs for this security. Accordingly, the trust preferred pooled security was classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The Company utilized observable inputs where available, unobservable data and modeled the cash flows adjusted by an appropriate liquidity and credit risk adjusted discount rate using an income approach valuation technique in order to measure the fair value of the security. Significant unobservable inputs were used that reflect the Company’s assumptions of what a market participant would use to price the security. Significant unobservable inputs included selecting an appropriate discount rate, default rate and repayment assumptions. The Company estimated the discount rate by comparing rates for similarly rated corporate bonds, with additional consideration given to market liquidity. The default rates and repayment assumptions were estimated based on the individual issuer’s financial conditions, historical repayment information, as well as our future expectations of the capital markets.

The following table represents certain loans and REO, which were marked down to their fair value for the year ended March 31, 2011. The following assets are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis (in thousands).

     
    
Fair value measurements at March 31, 2011, using
     
Quoted prices
in active
markets for
identical assets
 
Other
observable
inputs
 
Significant
unobservable
inputs
 
Fair value
March 31, 2011
 
(Level 1)
    
(Level 2)
    
(Level 3)
Loans measured for impairment
$
13,412
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
13,412
Real estate owned
 
30,007
   
-
   
-
   
30,007
                       
Total nonrecurring assets measured at fair value
$
43,419
 
$
-
 
$
-
 
$
43,419

The following method was used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instrument above:

Impaired loans – A loan is considered to be impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due (both interest and principal) according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. For information regarding the Company’s method for estimating the fair value of impaired loans, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Allowance for Loan Losses.
 
 
96

 

Real estate owned – REO is real property that the Bank has taken ownership of in partial or full satisfaction of a loan or loans. REO is recorded at the lower of the carrying amount of the loan or fair value less estimated costs to sell. This amount becomes the property’s new basis. Any write downs based on the property’s fair value less estimated costs to sell at the date of acquisition are charged to the allowance for loan losses. Management periodically reviews REO in an effort to ensure the property is carried at the lower of its new basis or fair value, net of estimated costs to sell.

20.   
FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The following disclosure of the estimated fair value of financial instruments is made in accordance with applicable accounting standards. The Company, using available market information and appropriate valuation methodologies, has determined the estimated fair value amounts. However, considerable judgment is necessary to interpret market data in the development of the estimates of fair value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could realize in the future. The use of different market assumptions and/or estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated fair value amounts.

The estimated fair value of financial instruments is as follows (in thousands):

   
March 31,
   
2011
   
2010
   
Carrying
Value
   
Fair
Value
   
Carrying
Value
   
Fair
Value
Assets:
                     
Cash
$
51,752
 
$
51,752
 
$
13,587
 
$
13,587
Certificates of deposit held for investment
 
14,900
   
15,006
   
-
   
-
Investment securities held to maturity
 
506
   
556
   
517
   
573
Investment securities available for sale
 
6,320
   
6,320
   
6,802
   
6,802
Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity
 
190
   
199
   
259
   
265
Mortgage-backed securities available for sale
 
1,777
   
1,777
   
2,828
   
2,828
Loans receivable, net
 
672,609
   
575,027
   
712,837
   
631,706
Loans held for sale
 
173
   
173
   
255
   
255
Mortgage servicing rights
 
396
   
970
   
509
   
1,015
                       
Liabilities:
                     
Demand – savings deposits
 
453,380
   
453,380
   
396,342
   
396,342
Time deposits
 
263,150
   
265,079
   
291,706
   
294,337
                       
FHLB advances
 
-
   
-
   
23,000
   
23,006
FRB borrowings
 
-
   
-
   
10,000
   
9,998
Junior subordinated debentures
 
22,681
   
13,574
   
22,681
   
14,124

 
Fair value estimates were based on existing financial instruments without attempting to estimate the value of anticipated future business. The fair value was not estimated for assets and liabilities that were not considered financial instruments.

Fair value estimates, methods and assumptions are set forth below.

Cash - Fair value approximates the carrying amount.

Certificates of Deposit held for investment – The fair value of certificates of deposit with stated maturity was based on the discounted value of contractual cash flows. The discount rate was estimated using rates currently available in the local market.

Investments and Mortgage-Backed Securities - Fair values were based on quoted market rates and dealer quotes. The fair value of the trust preferred investment was determined using a discounted cash flow method (see also Note 19 – Fair Value Measurements).

Loans Receivable and Loans Held for Sale – For year ended March 31, 2011, due primarily to fewer comparable loan statistics being available for performing loans, performing and noncriticized loans were priced using a discounted cash flow analysis. Nonperforming and criticized loans were priced using comparable market statistics. The nonperforming and criticized loan portfolio was segregated into various categories and a weighted average valuation discount that approximated similar loan sales was applied to each of these categories. The fair value of loans held for sale was based on the loans carrying value as the agreements to sell these loans are short term fixed rate commitments and no material difference between the carrying value is likely.
 
 
97

 

For the year ended March 31, 2010, the entire loan portfolio was priced using comparable market statistics.  The loan portfolio was segregated into various categories and a weighted average valuation discount that approximated similar loan sales was applied to each of these categories.

Mortgage Servicing Rights - The fair value of MSRs was determined using the Company’s model, which incorporates the expected life of the loans, estimated cost to service the loans, servicing fees received and other factors. The Company calculates MSRs fair value by stratifying MSRs based on the predominant risk characteristics that include the underlying loan’s interest rate, cash flows of the loan, origination date and term. Key economic assumptions that vary due to changes in market interest rates are used to determine the fair value of the MSRs and include expected prepayment speeds, which impact the average life of the portfolio, annual service cost, annual ancillary income and the discount rate used in valuing the cash flows. At March 31, 2011, the MSRs fair value totaled $970,000 which was estimated using a range of prepayment speed assumptions values that ranged from 150 to 595.

Deposits - The fair value of deposits with no stated maturity such as non-interest-bearing demand deposits, interest checking, money market and savings accounts was equal to the amount payable on demand. The fair value of time deposits with stated maturity was based on the discounted value of contractual cash flows. The discount rate was estimated using rates currently available in the local market.

Federal Home Loan Bank Advances - The fair value for FHLB advances was based on the discounted cash flow method. The discount rate was estimated using rates currently available from the FHLB.

Federal Reserve Bank Borrowings - The fair value for FRB borrowings was based on the discounted cash flow method. The discount rate was estimated using rates currently available from the FRB.

Junior Subordinated Debentures - The fair value of the Debentures was based on the discounted cash flow method. Management believes that the discount rate utilized is indicative of those that would be used by market participants for similar types of debentures.

Off-Balance Sheet Financial Instruments - The estimated fair value of loan commitments approximates fees recorded associated with such commitments as of March 31, 2011 and 2010. Since the majority of the Bank’s off-balance-sheet instruments consist of non-fee producing, variable rate commitments, the Bank has determined they do not have a distinguishable fair value.

21.   
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments generally include commitments to originate mortgage, commercial and consumer loans. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the balance sheet. The Company’s maximum exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the borrower is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments as it does for on-balance sheet instruments. Commitments to originate loans are conditional, and are honored for up to 45 days subject to the Company’s usual terms and conditions. Collateral is not required to support commitments. At March 31, 2011, the Company had outstanding commitments to extend credit totaling $8.1 million, unused lines of credit totaling $69.8 million and undisbursed construction loans totaling $15.8 million.

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Bank to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Those guarantees are primarily used to support public and private borrowing arrangements. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. Collateral held varies as specified above, and is required in instances where the Bank deems necessary. At March 31, 2011 and 2010, standby letters of credit totaled $1.1 million and $1.4 million, respectively.

In connection with certain asset sales, the Bank typically makes representation and warranties about the underlying assets conforming to specified guidelines. If the underlying assets do not conform to the specifications, the Bank may have an obligation to repurchase the assets or indemnify the purchaser against loss. As of March 31, 2011, loans under warranty totaled $103.4 million, which substantially represents the unpaid principal balance of the Bank’s loans serviced for FHLMC. The Bank believes that the potential for loss under these arrangements is remote. Accordingly, no contingent liability is recorded in the Consolidated Financial Statements. At March 31, 2011, the Company had firm commitments to sell $423,000 of residential loans to FHLMC. Typically, these agreements are short term fixed rate commitments and no material gain or loss is likely.
 
 
98

 

The Bank is a public depository and, accordingly, accepts deposit and other public funds belonging to, or held for the benefit of, Washington and Oregon states, political subdivisions thereof and, municipal corporations.  In accordance with applicable state law, in the event of default of a participating bank, all other participating banks in the state collectively assure that no loss of funds are suffered by any public depositor.  Generally, in the event of default by a public depositary, the assessment attributable to all public depositaries is allocated on a pro rata basis in proportion to the maximum liability of each depository as it existed on the date of loss.  The Company has not incurred any losses related to public depository funds for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

The Company is party to litigation arising in the ordinary course of business. In the opinion of management, these actions will not have a material adverse effect, if any, on the Company’s financial position or results of operations.

The Bank has entered into employment contracts with certain key employees, which provide for contingent payment subject to future events.


 
99 

 

22.  
RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. (PARENT COMPANY)


BALANCE SHEETS
         
MARCH 31, 2011 AND 2010
         
(In thousands)
 
 
2011
   
2010
ASSETS
         
Cash and cash equivalents (including interest earning accounts of
    $4,000 and $159)
$
4,059
 
$
190
Investment in the Bank
 
116,750
   
104,724
Real estate owned – held for investment
 
8,328
   
-
Other assets
 
1,808
   
1,765
TOTAL ASSETS
$
130,945
 
$
106,679
           
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
         
           
    Accrued expenses and other liabilities
$
1,305
 
$
59
Deferred income taxes
 
15
   
5
Borrowings
 
22,681
   
22,681
Shareholders' equity
 
106,944
   
83,934
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
$
130,945
 
$
106,679

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                 
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 AND 2009
                 
(In thousands)
 
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
INCOME:
                 
Dividend income from Bank
$
-
 
$
300
 
$
-
 
Interest on investment securities and other short-term investments
 
44
   
37
   
114
 
Interest on loan receivable from the Bank
 
68
   
77
   
86
 
Total income
 
112
   
414
   
200
 
                   
EXPENSE:
                 
Management service fees paid to the Bank
 
143
   
143
   
143
 
Other expenses
 
1,316
   
1,318
   
1,656
 
Total expense
 
1,459
   
1,461
   
1,799
 
LOSS BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND EQUITY
                 
IN UNDISTRIBUTED INCOME (LOSS) OF THE BANK
 
(1,347
)
 
(1,047
)
 
(1,599
)
BENEFIT FOR INCOME TAXES
 
(458
)
 
(458
)
 
(544
)
LOSS OF PARENT COMPANY
 
(889
)
 
(589
)
 
(1,055
)
EQUITY IN UNDISTRIBUTED INCOME (LOSS) OF THE BANK
 
5,204
   
(4,855
)
 
(1,595
)
NET INCOME (LOSS)
$
4,315
 
$
(5,444
)
$
(2,650
)

 
100 

 


RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. (PARENT COMPANY)

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 2011, 2010 AND 2009

(In thousands)
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
                 
Net income (loss)
$
4,315
 
$
(5,444
)
$
(2,650
)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) cash provided by
(used in) operating activities:
                 
Equity in undistributed (earnings) loss of the Bank
 
(5,204
)
 
4,855
   
1,595
 
Provision (benefit) for deferred income taxes
 
10
   
(7
)
 
-
 
Earned ESOP shares
 
64
   
73
   
43
 
    Stock based compensation
 
77
   
112
   
-
 
Changes in assets and liabilities
                 
Other assets
 
(43
)
 
(413
)
 
965
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
 
1,209
   
(91
)
 
(87
)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
 
428
   
(915
)
 
(134
)
                   
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
                 
  Purchase of real estate held for investment
 
(8,328
)
 
-
   
-
 
  Additional investment in subsidiary
 
(7,000
)
 
-
   
(4,750
)
   Net cash used in investing activities
 
(15,328
)
 
-
   
(4,750
)
                   
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                 
Dividends paid
 
-
   
-
   
(2,402
)
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net
 
18,769
   
-
   
-
 
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
 
-
   
-
   
96
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
18,769
   
-
   
(2,306
)
                   
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALNETS
 
3,869
   
(915
)
 
(7,190
)
                   
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF YEAR
 
190
   
1,105
   
8,295
 
                   
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF YEAR
$
4,059
 
$
190
 
$
1,105
 


 
101 

 

RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC.
SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED):

(Dollars in thousands, except share data)
Three Months Ended
 
   
March 31
     
December 31
     
September 30
     
June 30
 
Fiscal 2011:
                             
Interest income
$
10,388
   
$
10,733
   
$
10,789
   
$
11,304
 
Interest expense
 
1,701
     
1,926
     
2,139
     
2,286
 
Net interest income
 
8,687
     
8,807
     
8,650
     
9,018
 
Provision for loan losses
 
500
     
1,600
     
1,675
     
1,300
 
Non-interest income
 
1,739
     
1,864
     
2,050
     
2,236
 
Non-interest expense
 
8,566
     
8,253
     
7,412
     
7,265
 
Income before income taxes
 
1,360
     
818
     
1,613
     
2,689
 
Provision for income taxes
 
506
     
239
     
496
     
924
 
                               
           Net income
$
854
   
$
579
   
$
1,117
   
$
1,765
 
                               
        Basic earnings per share (1)
$
0.04
   
$
0.03
   
$
0.06
   
$
0.16
 
                               
        Diluted earnings per share (1)
$
0.04
   
$
0.03
   
$
0.06
   
$
0.16
 
Fiscal 2010:
                             
Interest income
$
11,058
   
$
11,513
   
$
11,797
   
$
11,894
 
Interest expense
 
2,491
     
2,787
     
2,884
     
3,214
 
Net interest income
 
8,567
     
8,726
     
8,913
     
8,680
 
Provision for loan losses
 
5,850
     
4,500
     
3,200
     
2,350
 
Non-interest income
 
1,846
     
1,522
     
1,795
     
2,103
 
Non-interest expense
 
11,926
     
7,792
     
7,267
     
7,988
 
Income before income taxes
 
(7,363
)
   
(2,044
)
   
241
     
445
 
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
 
(2,660
)
   
(758
)
   
39
     
102
 
                               
Net income (loss)
$
(4,703
)
 
$
(1,286
)
 
$
202
   
$
343
 
                               
        Basic earnings (loss) per share (1)
$
(0.44
)
 
$
(0.12
)
 
$
0.02
   
$
0.03
 
                               
        Diluted earnings (loss) per share (1)
$
(0.44
)
 
$
(0.12
)
 
$
0.02
   
$
0.03
 
          (1) Quarterly earnings per share may vary from annual earnings per share due to rounding.

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Not Applicable

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures:  We maintain a system of disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13(a)-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act (the "Exchange Act")) that is designed to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported accurately and within the time periods specified in the SEC's rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, as appropriate. An evaluation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and several other members of the Company’s senior management as of the end of the period covered by this report.  The Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as in effect on March 31, 2011, were effective in ensuring that the information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports it files or submits under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 is (i) accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management (including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer) in a timely manner, and (ii) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms as of the end of the period covered by this report.

The Company does not expect that its disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting will prevent all error and all fraud. A control procedure, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control procedure are met. Because of the inherent limitations in
 
 
102

 
 
all control procedures, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the control. The design of any control procedure also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions; over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control procedure, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.

(b)  Changes in Internal Controls:  There was no change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the Company’s most recently completed fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

(c) Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting:
 
The management of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting.  This internal control system has been designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and board of directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of the company’s published financial statements.
 
 
All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations.  Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation.
 
The management of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. has assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2011.  To make the assessment, we used the criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in Internal Control – Integrated Framework, issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  Based on our assessment, we believe that, as of March 31, 2011, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective based on those criteria.

The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm that audits the Company’s consolidated financial statements has audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2011, as stated in their report appearing below.


 
103 

 


 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Riverview Bancorp, Inc.
Vancouver, Washington
 
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Riverview Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiary (the "Company") as of March 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.  Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances.  We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company's principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company's board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis.  Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2011, based on the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended March 31, 2011 of the Company and our report dated June 8, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.
 
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

Portland, Oregon
June 8, 2011

 
104 

 

Item 9B. Other Information

There was no information to be disclosed by the Company in a report on Form 8-K during the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2011 that was not so disclosed.
 
PART III

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information contained under the section captioned "Proposal I - Election of Directors" contained in the Company's Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, and "Part I -- Business -- Personnel -- Executive Officers" of this Form 10-K, is incorporated herein by reference.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance.

The information concerning compliance with the reporting requirements of Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 by directors, officers and ten percent stockholders of the Company required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from the Company’s definitive proxy statement for its 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders.

Code of Ethics

In December 2003, the Board of Directors adopted the Officer and Director Code of Ethics.  The code is applicable to each of the Company’s officers, including the principal executive officer and senior financial officers, and requires individuals to maintain the highest standards of professional conduct.  A copy of the Code of Ethics is available on the Company’s website at www.riverviewbank.com.

Audit Committee Matters and Audit Committee Financial Expert

The Company has a separately-designated standing Audit Committee, composed of Directors Gary R. Douglass, Gerald L. Nies and Jerry C. Olson.  Each member of the Audit Committee is “independent” as defined in the Nasdaq Stock Market Listing Standards.  The Company’s Board of Directors has Mr. Douglass, Audit Committee Chairman, as its financial expert, as defined in SEC’s Regulation S-K.

Nomination Procedures

There have been no material changes to the procedures by which shareholders may recommend nominees to the Company’s Board of Directors.

Item 11.  Executive Compensation

The information set forth under the sections captioned "Executive Compensation" and "Directors' Compensation" under "Proposal I - Election of Directors" in the Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders (excluding the information contained under the heading “Personnel/Compensation Committee Report,”) is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information set forth under the caption "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management" in the Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders is incorporated herein by reference.

 
105 

 


Equity Compensation Plan Information.  The following table summarizes share and exercise price information about the Company’s equity compensation plan as of March 31, 2011.

Plan category
 
Number of
securities to be
issued upon
exercise of
outstanding
options
   
Weighted-
average  
price of
outstanding
options
 
Number of
securities
remaining
available for
future issuance
under equity
compensation
plans excluding
securities
reflected in
column (A)
                   
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders:
   
(A)
   
(B)
   
(C)
2003 Stock Option Plan
   
355,000
   
9.21
   
75,154
1998 Stock Option Plan
   
113,700
   
8.38
   
-
                   
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders:
   
-
   
-
   
-
                   
Total
   
468,700
         
75,154

Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions; and Director Independence

The information set forth under the headings “Related Party Transactions” and “Director Independence” in the Proxy Statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14.  Principal Accounting Fees and Services

The information set forth under the section captioned “Independent Auditor” in the Proxy statement for the 2011 Annual Meeting of Stockholders (excluding the information contained under the heading of “Report of the Audit Committee”) is incorporated herein by reference.

 
106 

 

PART IV
Item 15.  Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
 
 
(a)  1.  Financial Statements 
    See “Part II –Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” 
     
  2. 
Financial Statement Schedules
All schedules are omitted because they are not required or applicable, or the required information is shown in the consolidated financial statements or the notes thereto. 
 
3. 
Exhibits
 
 
3.1
Articles of Incorporation of the Registrant (1)
 
3.2
Bylaws of the Registrant (1)
 
4
Form of Certificate of Common Stock of the Registrant (1)
 
10.1
Form of Employment Agreement between the Bank and each of Patrick Sheaffer, Ronald A. Wysaske, David A. Dahlstrom and John A. Karas (2)
 
10.2
Employee Severance Compensation Plan (3)
 
10.3
Employee Stock Ownership Plan (4)
 
10.4
1998 Stock Option Plan (5)
 
10.5
2003 Stock Option Plan (6)
 
10.6
Form of Incentive Stock Option Award Pursuant to 2003 Stock Option Plan (7)
 
10.7
Form of Non-qualified Stock Option Award Pursuant to 2003 Stock Option Plan (7)
 
11
Statement of recomputation of per share earnings (See Note 18 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained herein.)
 
21
Subsidiaries of Registrant (8)
 
23
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
31.1
    Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act
 
31.2
Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act
 
32
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act

(1)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-30203), and incorporated herein by reference.
(2)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 18, 2007, and incorporated herein by reference.
(3)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1997, and incorporated herein by reference.
(4)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended March 31, 1998, and incorporated herein by reference.
(5)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (Registration No. 333-66049), and incorporated herein by reference.
(6)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Definitive Annual Meeting Proxy Statement (000-22957), filed with the Commission on June 5, 2003, and incorporated herein by reference.
(7)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended December 31, 2005, and incorporated herein by reference.
(8)
Filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended March 31, 2007, and incorporated herein by reference.

 
107 

 

 
SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
  RIVERVIEW BANCORP, INC. 
   
   
Date:  June 2, 2011 
By:   /s/ Patrick Sheaffer                     
           Patrick Sheaffer
           Chairman of the Board and 
           Chief Executive Officer 
           (Duly Authorized Representative)
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 

 
By:  /s/ Patrick Sheaffer   By:  /s/ Ronald A. Wysaske
  Patrick Sheaffer      Ronald A. Wysaske 
 
Chairman of the Board and
   
President and Chief Operating Officer
 
Chief Executive Officer
   
Director
  (Principal Executive Officer)       
         
Date:  June 2, 2011    Date:  June 2, 2011 
         
By:  /s/ Kevin J. Lycklama   By:  /s/ Bess R. Wills
  Kevin J. Lycklama      Bess R. Wills 
  Executive Vice President and      Director
  Chief Financial Officer       
  (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)       
         
Date:  June 2, 2011    Date:  June 2, 2011 
         
By:  /s/ Gary R. Douglass   By:  /s/ Edward R. Geiger
  Gary R. Douglass      Edward R. Geiger 
 
Director
    Director
         
Date:  June 2, 2011    Date:  June 2, 2011 
         
By:  /s/ Michael D. Allen   By:  /s/ Jerry C. Olson
 
Michael D. Allen
   
Jerry C. Olson
  Director     Director
         
Date:  June 2, 2011    Date:  June 2, 2011 
         
By:  /s/ Gerald L. Nies      
  Gerald L. Nies       
  Director      
         
Date:  June 2, 2011       


 
108 

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

Exhibit 23            Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Exhibit 31.1         Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Exhibit 31.2         Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Exhibit 32
Certification of Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350 as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 
 

 
 
109